1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 /* 3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface 4 * 5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc. 6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz> 7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2022 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #ifndef MAC80211_H 14 #define MAC80211_H 15 16 #include <linux/bug.h> 17 #include <linux/kernel.h> 18 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 19 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 21 #include <linux/lockdep.h> 22 #include <net/cfg80211.h> 23 #include <net/codel.h> 24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h> 25 #include <asm/unaligned.h> 26 27 /** 28 * DOC: Introduction 29 * 30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements 31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document 32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware 33 * drivers. 34 */ 35 36 /** 37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts 38 * 39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be 40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any 41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such 42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the 43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even 44 * tasklet function. 45 * 46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also 47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions! 48 */ 49 50 /** 51 * DOC: Warning 52 * 53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will 54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet. 55 */ 56 57 /** 58 * DOC: Frame format 59 * 60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver, 61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are 62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the 63 * hardware. 64 * 65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features: 66 * 67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload 68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware. 69 * 70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to 71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU. 72 */ 73 74 /** 75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue 76 * 77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use. 78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by 79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the 80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback. 81 * 82 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during 83 * suspend. 84 * 85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock. 86 * 87 */ 88 89 /** 90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing 91 * 92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the 93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between 94 * different stations/interfaces. 95 * 96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either 97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom 98 * handler. 99 * 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames. 103 * 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops. 106 * 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly. 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue 109 * driver op. 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation. 113 * 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using 118 * ieee80211_return_txq(). 119 * 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls 124 * .release_buffered_frames(). 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue). 128 */ 129 130 /** 131 * DOC: HW timestamping 132 * 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks. 135 * 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct. 140 * 141 * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct. 145 */ 146 struct device; 147 148 /** 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues 150 * 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues. 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set 153 */ 154 enum ieee80211_max_queues { 155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16, 156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1, 157 }; 158 159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff 160 161 /** 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background 167 */ 168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers { 169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0, 170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1, 171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2, 172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3, 173 }; 174 175 /** 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration 177 * 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29. 180 * 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255] 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form 183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min] 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE 190 */ 191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params { 192 u16 txop; 193 u16 cw_min; 194 u16 cw_max; 195 u8 aifs; 196 bool acm; 197 bool uapsd; 198 bool mu_edca; 199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec; 200 }; 201 202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats { 203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount; 204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount; 205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount; 206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount; 207 }; 208 209 /** 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel, 215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed 217 */ 218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change { 219 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0), 220 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1), 221 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2), 222 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3), 223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4), 224 }; 225 226 /** 227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to 228 * 229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx 230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only. 231 * 232 * @def: the channel definition 233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required. 234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be 235 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions 236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled 237 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions; 238 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static. 239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel. 240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 241 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information. 242 */ 243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf { 244 struct cfg80211_chan_def def; 245 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def; 246 247 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic; 248 249 bool radar_enabled; 250 251 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 252 }; 253 254 /** 255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode 256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already 257 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface 258 * needs to be switched from one to the other. 259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop 260 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but 261 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches 262 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course 263 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing 264 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context 265 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used 266 * for changes/removal.) 267 */ 268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode { 269 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF, 270 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS, 271 }; 272 273 /** 274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information 275 * 276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that 277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The 278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be 279 * done. 280 * 281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx 282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching 283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned 284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned 285 */ 286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch { 287 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 288 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf; 289 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx; 290 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx; 291 }; 292 293 /** 294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags 295 * 296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed() 297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed. 298 * 299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated), 300 * also implies a change in the AID. 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed 304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed 306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed 307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever 308 * reason (IBSS and managed mode) 309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve 310 * new beacon (beaconing modes) 311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be 312 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes) 313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed 314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed 315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed. 316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note 317 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode. 318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface. 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode) 320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode) 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode) 322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS) 324 * changed 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available: 326 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration. 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed, 328 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel 329 * context had been assigned. 330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed 332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected 333 * keep alive) changed. 334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder 336 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode). 337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed. 339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed. 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 342 * status changed. 343 * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed. 344 */ 345 enum ieee80211_bss_change { 346 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0, 347 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1, 348 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2, 349 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3, 350 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4, 351 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5, 352 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6, 353 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7, 354 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8, 355 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9, 356 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10, 357 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11, 358 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12, 359 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13, 360 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14, 361 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15, 362 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16, 363 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17, 364 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18, 365 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19, 366 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20, 367 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21, 368 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22, 369 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23, 370 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24, 371 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25, 372 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26, 373 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27, 374 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28, 375 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29, 376 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30, 377 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31, 378 BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING = BIT_ULL(32), 379 380 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */ 381 }; 382 383 /* 384 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number 385 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP 386 * filtering will be disabled. 387 */ 388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4 389 390 /** 391 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver 392 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver. 393 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME 394 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received 395 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because 396 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only 397 * once each time the timeout triggers. 398 */ 399 enum ieee80211_event_type { 400 RSSI_EVENT, 401 MLME_EVENT, 402 BAR_RX_EVENT, 403 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT, 404 }; 405 406 /** 407 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT 408 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver. 409 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver. 410 */ 411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data { 412 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH, 413 RSSI_EVENT_LOW, 414 }; 415 416 /** 417 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT 418 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data 419 */ 420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event { 421 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data; 422 }; 423 424 /** 425 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 426 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication 427 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association 428 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received.. 429 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent. 430 */ 431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data { 432 AUTH_EVENT, 433 ASSOC_EVENT, 434 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT, 435 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT, 436 }; 437 438 /** 439 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 440 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully. 441 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer. 442 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out. 443 */ 444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status { 445 MLME_SUCCESS, 446 MLME_DENIED, 447 MLME_TIMEOUT, 448 }; 449 450 /** 451 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT 452 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data 453 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status 454 * @reason: the reason code if applicable 455 */ 456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event { 457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data; 458 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status; 459 u16 reason; 460 }; 461 462 /** 463 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events 464 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates 465 * @tid: the tid 466 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT) 467 */ 468 struct ieee80211_ba_event { 469 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 470 u16 tid; 471 u16 ssn; 472 }; 473 474 /** 475 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver 476 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type. 477 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT 478 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT 479 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT 480 * @u:union holding the fields above 481 */ 482 struct ieee80211_event { 483 enum ieee80211_event_type type; 484 union { 485 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi; 486 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme; 487 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba; 488 } u; 489 }; 490 491 /** 492 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data 493 * 494 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO 495 * 496 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 497 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 498 */ 499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data { 500 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN]; 501 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN]; 502 }; 503 504 /** 505 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters 506 * 507 * @lci: LCI subelement content 508 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content 509 * @lci_len: LCI data length 510 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length 511 */ 512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params { 513 const u8 *lci; 514 const u8 *civicloc; 515 size_t lci_len; 516 size_t civicloc_len; 517 }; 518 519 /** 520 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 521 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 522 * 523 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 524 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 525 */ 526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery { 527 u32 min_interval; 528 u32 max_interval; 529 }; 530 531 /** 532 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters 533 * 534 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association 535 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS. 536 * 537 * @addr: (link) address used locally 538 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO 539 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE 540 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP 541 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either 542 * ACK, BACK or both 543 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field 544 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us 545 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE 546 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 547 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 548 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 549 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 550 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames 551 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT 552 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection 553 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble 554 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP) 555 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing, 556 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified 557 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then. 558 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old 559 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the 560 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can 561 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after 562 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the 563 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 564 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf, 565 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation 566 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 567 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY 568 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts. 569 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync 570 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently 571 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks. 572 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't 573 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this. 574 * @beacon_int: beacon interval 575 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp 576 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an 577 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in 578 * the current band. 579 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate 580 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 581 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS 582 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not 583 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be 584 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example. 585 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data 586 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation. 587 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel. 588 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must 589 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT. 590 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value 591 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should 592 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in 593 * relation to the newly configured threshold. 594 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value 595 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single 596 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it. 597 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold. 598 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis 599 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS. 600 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode. 601 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured. 602 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit 603 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular 604 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is 605 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from 606 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to 607 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace) 608 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave 609 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed 610 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS 611 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support. 612 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from 613 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated. 614 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include 615 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element. 616 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN 617 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the 618 * station. 619 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM 620 * responder functionality. 621 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder. 622 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile 623 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP 624 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set 625 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set 626 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of 627 * nontransmitted BSSIDs 628 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received 629 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set. 630 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are 631 * connected to (STA) 632 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters. 633 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE 634 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration 635 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 636 * interval. 637 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed 638 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware. 639 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz 640 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS. 641 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env. 642 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS. 643 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT 644 * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS 645 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is 646 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine 647 * for read access. 648 * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch 649 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability 650 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL 651 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX 652 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always 653 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be 654 * processed after it switches back to %NULL. 655 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is 656 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine 657 * for read access. 658 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change. 659 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 660 * beamformer 661 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 662 * beamformee 663 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 664 * beamformer 665 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 666 * beamformee 667 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 668 * beamformer 669 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 670 * beamformee 671 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU 672 * beamformer 673 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission 674 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU 675 * bandwidth 676 */ 677 struct ieee80211_bss_conf { 678 const u8 *bssid; 679 unsigned int link_id; 680 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 681 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext; 682 bool uora_exists; 683 u8 uora_ocw_range; 684 u16 frame_time_rts_th; 685 bool he_support; 686 bool twt_requester; 687 bool twt_responder; 688 bool twt_protected; 689 bool twt_broadcast; 690 /* erp related data */ 691 bool use_cts_prot; 692 bool use_short_preamble; 693 bool use_short_slot; 694 bool enable_beacon; 695 u8 dtim_period; 696 u16 beacon_int; 697 u16 assoc_capability; 698 u64 sync_tsf; 699 u32 sync_device_ts; 700 u8 sync_dtim_count; 701 u32 basic_rates; 702 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate; 703 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 704 u16 ht_operation_mode; 705 s32 cqm_rssi_thold; 706 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst; 707 s32 cqm_rssi_low; 708 s32 cqm_rssi_high; 709 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 710 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group; 711 bool qos; 712 bool hidden_ssid; 713 int txpower; 714 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type; 715 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr; 716 bool allow_p2p_go_ps; 717 u16 max_idle_period; 718 bool protected_keep_alive; 719 bool ftm_responder; 720 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params; 721 /* Multiple BSSID data */ 722 bool nontransmitted; 723 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 724 u8 bssid_index; 725 u8 bssid_indicator; 726 bool ema_ap; 727 u8 profile_periodicity; 728 struct { 729 u32 params; 730 u16 nss_set; 731 } he_oper; 732 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 733 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 734 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 735 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval; 736 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate; 737 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type; 738 struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT]; 739 u8 tx_pwr_env_num; 740 u8 pwr_reduction; 741 bool eht_support; 742 u16 eht_puncturing; 743 744 bool csa_active; 745 u16 csa_punct_bitmap; 746 747 bool mu_mimo_owner; 748 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf; 749 750 bool color_change_active; 751 u8 color_change_color; 752 753 bool vht_su_beamformer; 754 bool vht_su_beamformee; 755 bool vht_mu_beamformer; 756 bool vht_mu_beamformee; 757 bool he_su_beamformer; 758 bool he_su_beamformee; 759 bool he_mu_beamformer; 760 bool he_full_ul_mumimo; 761 }; 762 763 /** 764 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status 765 * 766 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info. 767 * 768 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame. 769 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence 770 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment 771 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the 772 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly 773 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly 774 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from 775 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing. 776 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to 777 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE 778 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for 779 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field. 780 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack 781 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination 782 * station 783 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame 784 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon 785 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU 786 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211. 787 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted 788 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to 789 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or 790 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station 791 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on 792 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for 793 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above), 794 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the 795 * hardware queue. 796 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged 797 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status 798 * is for the whole aggregation. 799 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned, 800 * so consider using block ack request (BAR). 801 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be 802 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will 803 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment) 804 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate 805 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for 806 * off-channel operation. 807 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation 808 * (header conversion) 809 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211, 810 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS 811 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211, 812 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted 813 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll 814 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must 815 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode. 816 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the 817 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used 818 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the 819 * queue gets full. 820 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted 821 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not 822 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.) 823 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME 824 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status 825 * should kick the MLME state machine. 826 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211 827 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX 828 * status to user space) 829 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame 830 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this 831 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use. 832 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on 833 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done 834 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be 835 * handled properly by the device. 836 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP 837 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow 838 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested. 839 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate. 840 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P 841 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band. 842 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period, 843 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in 844 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames 845 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for 846 * PS-Poll responses. 847 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate. 848 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when 849 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose. 850 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it 851 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for 852 * monitor injection). 853 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with 854 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without 855 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW). 856 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack 857 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK. 858 * 859 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't 860 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary. 861 */ 862 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags { 863 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0), 864 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1), 865 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2), 866 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3), 867 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4), 868 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5), 869 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6), 870 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7), 871 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8), 872 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9), 873 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10), 874 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11), 875 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12), 876 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13), 877 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14), 878 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15), 879 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16), 880 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17), 881 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18), 882 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19), 883 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20), 884 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21), 885 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22), 886 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24), 887 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25), 888 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26), 889 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27), 890 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28), 891 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29), 892 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30), 893 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31), 894 }; 895 896 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23 897 898 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS 899 900 /** 901 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control 902 * 903 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control 904 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP) 905 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll 906 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD). 907 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information 908 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame 909 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path 910 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup 911 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211, 912 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before 913 * it can be sent out. 914 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that 915 * has already been assigned to this frame. 916 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered 917 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent 918 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values. 919 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally 920 * for sequence number assignment 921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this 922 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is 923 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is 924 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame 925 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if 926 * it's intended for an MLD. 927 * 928 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags. 929 */ 930 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags { 931 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0), 932 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1), 933 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2), 934 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3), 935 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4), 936 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5), 937 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6), 938 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7), 939 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8), 940 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9), 941 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000, 942 }; 943 944 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf 945 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \ 946 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \ 947 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK) 948 949 /** 950 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status 951 * 952 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid 953 * 954 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags. 955 */ 956 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags { 957 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0), 958 }; 959 960 /* 961 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are 962 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack. 963 */ 964 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \ 965 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \ 966 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \ 967 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \ 968 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \ 969 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \ 970 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \ 971 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 972 973 /** 974 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the 975 * Rate Control algorithm. 976 * 977 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx, 978 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate. 979 * 980 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate. 981 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required. 982 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection. 983 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble. 984 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate. 985 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split 986 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number) 987 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in 988 * Greenfield mode. 989 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz. 990 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission 991 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission 992 * (80+80 isn't supported yet) 993 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the 994 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is 995 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS. 996 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate. 997 */ 998 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags { 999 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0), 1000 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1), 1001 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2), 1002 1003 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */ 1004 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3), 1005 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4), 1006 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5), 1007 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6), 1008 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7), 1009 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8), 1010 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9), 1011 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10), 1012 }; 1013 1014 1015 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */ 1016 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40 1017 1018 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */ 1019 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24 1020 1021 /* maximum number of rate stages */ 1022 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4 1023 1024 /* maximum number of rate table entries */ 1025 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4 1026 1027 /** 1028 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status 1029 * 1030 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with 1031 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags) 1032 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate 1033 * 1034 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used 1035 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried. 1036 * 1037 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should 1038 * always report the rate along with the flags it used. 1039 * 1040 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs 1041 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate 1042 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example, 1043 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the 1044 * information:: 1045 * 1046 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 } 1047 * 1048 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted 1049 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four 1050 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets 1051 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status 1052 * information should then contain:: 1053 * 1054 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ... 1055 * 1056 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2 1057 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement. 1058 */ 1059 struct ieee80211_tx_rate { 1060 s8 idx; 1061 u16 count:5, 1062 flags:11; 1063 } __packed; 1064 1065 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31 1066 1067 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate, 1068 u8 mcs, u8 nss) 1069 { 1070 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF); 1071 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7); 1072 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs; 1073 } 1074 1075 static inline u8 1076 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1077 { 1078 return rate->idx & 0xF; 1079 } 1080 1081 static inline u8 1082 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1083 { 1084 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1; 1085 } 1086 1087 /** 1088 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information 1089 * 1090 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses: 1091 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do 1092 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable) 1093 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened 1094 * 1095 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above 1096 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races), 1097 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which 1098 * link the frame will be transmitted on 1099 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC 1100 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally 1101 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally 1102 * @control: union part for control data 1103 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try 1104 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS 1105 * @control.use_rts: use RTS 1106 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS 1107 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only) 1108 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table 1109 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients 1110 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL) 1111 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL) 1112 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags 1113 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs) 1114 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space 1115 * @pad: padding 1116 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates 1117 * @status: union part for status data 1118 * @status.rates: attempted rates 1119 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal 1120 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length 1121 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length 1122 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy) 1123 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only 1124 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness 1125 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags 1126 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area 1127 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data 1128 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK 1129 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers 1130 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames. 1131 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. 1132 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames. 1133 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. 1134 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame 1135 */ 1136 struct ieee80211_tx_info { 1137 /* common information */ 1138 u32 flags; 1139 u32 band:3, 1140 ack_frame_id:13, 1141 hw_queue:4, 1142 tx_time_est:10; 1143 /* 2 free bits */ 1144 1145 union { 1146 struct { 1147 union { 1148 /* rate control */ 1149 struct { 1150 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[ 1151 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1152 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx; 1153 u8 use_rts:1; 1154 u8 use_cts_prot:1; 1155 u8 short_preamble:1; 1156 u8 skip_table:1; 1157 /* 2 bytes free */ 1158 }; 1159 /* only needed before rate control */ 1160 unsigned long jiffies; 1161 }; 1162 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */ 1163 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 1164 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key; 1165 u32 flags; 1166 codel_time_t enqueue_time; 1167 } control; 1168 struct { 1169 u64 cookie; 1170 } ack; 1171 struct { 1172 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1173 s32 ack_signal; 1174 u8 ampdu_ack_len; 1175 u8 ampdu_len; 1176 u8 antenna; 1177 u16 tx_time; 1178 u8 flags; 1179 void *status_driver_data[18 / sizeof(void *)]; 1180 } status; 1181 struct { 1182 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[ 1183 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1184 u8 pad[4]; 1185 1186 void *rate_driver_data[ 1187 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1188 }; 1189 void *driver_data[ 1190 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1191 }; 1192 }; 1193 1194 static inline u16 1195 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est) 1196 { 1197 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime 1198 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1 1199 */ 1200 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2; 1201 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1202 } 1203 1204 static inline u16 1205 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1206 { 1207 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1208 } 1209 1210 /*** 1211 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path 1212 * 1213 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a 1214 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet. 1215 * 1216 * @rate_idx The actual used rate. 1217 * @try_count How often the rate was tried. 1218 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the 1219 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level 1220 * that was used when sending the packet. 1221 */ 1222 struct ieee80211_rate_status { 1223 struct rate_info rate_idx; 1224 u8 try_count; 1225 u8 tx_power_idx; 1226 }; 1227 1228 /** 1229 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control 1230 * 1231 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for 1232 * @info: Basic tx status information 1233 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver) 1234 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet 1235 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates) 1236 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver 1237 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds 1238 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action 1239 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1240 */ 1241 struct ieee80211_tx_status { 1242 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 1243 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info; 1244 struct sk_buff *skb; 1245 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates; 1246 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp; 1247 u8 n_rates; 1248 1249 struct list_head *free_list; 1250 }; 1251 1252 /** 1253 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs 1254 * 1255 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan 1256 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace 1257 * and the ones generated by mac80211. 1258 * 1259 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs. 1260 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs. 1261 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones) 1262 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies 1263 */ 1264 struct ieee80211_scan_ies { 1265 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1266 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1267 const u8 *common_ies; 1268 size_t common_ie_len; 1269 }; 1270 1271 1272 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1273 { 1274 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb; 1275 } 1276 1277 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1278 { 1279 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb; 1280 } 1281 1282 /** 1283 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status 1284 * 1285 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared. 1286 * 1287 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report 1288 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything 1289 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear 1290 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway). 1291 * 1292 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the 1293 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore 1294 * any fields it needs after calling this helper. 1295 */ 1296 static inline void 1297 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1298 { 1299 int i; 1300 1301 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1302 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates)); 1303 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1304 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates)); 1305 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8); 1306 /* clear the rate counts */ 1307 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++) 1308 info->status.rates[i].count = 0; 1309 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates); 1310 } 1311 1312 1313 /** 1314 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags 1315 * 1316 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status. 1317 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame. 1318 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED. 1319 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware. 1320 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame, 1321 * verification has been done by the hardware. 1322 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame. 1323 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection 1324 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that. 1325 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this 1326 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection. 1327 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame 1328 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set) 1329 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did 1330 * de-duplication by itself. 1331 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on 1332 * the frame. 1333 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on 1334 * the frame. 1335 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1336 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU 1337 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS 1338 * merging. 1339 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1340 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU 1341 * (including FCS) was received. 1342 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1343 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received. 1344 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present. 1345 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU) 1346 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference 1347 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for 1348 * each A-MPDU 1349 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all 1350 * subframes of a single A-MPDU 1351 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU 1352 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected 1353 * on this subframe 1354 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC 1355 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field) 1356 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was 1357 * done by the hardware 1358 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without 1359 * processing it in any regular way. 1360 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1361 * them for sniffing purposes. 1362 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except 1363 * monitor interfaces. 1364 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1365 * them for sniffing purposes. 1366 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU 1367 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons. 1368 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g. 1369 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while 1370 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to 1371 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU 1372 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be 1373 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be 1374 * interleaved with other frames. 1375 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific 1376 * radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by 1377 * the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap. 1378 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before. 1379 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as 1380 * the first subframe. 1381 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must 1382 * be done in the hardware. 1383 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this 1384 * frame 1385 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known 1386 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present 1387 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in 1388 * 1389 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS 1390 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM 1391 * - DATA3_CODING 1392 * - DATA5_GI 1393 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC 1394 * - DATA6_NSTS 1395 * - DATA3_STBC 1396 * 1397 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data) 1398 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present 1399 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu) 1400 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present 1401 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with 1402 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is 1403 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't 1404 * known the frame shouldn't be reported. 1405 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by 1406 * hardware or driver) 1407 */ 1408 enum mac80211_rx_flags { 1409 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0), 1410 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1), 1411 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = BIT(2), 1412 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3), 1413 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4), 1414 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5), 1415 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6), 1416 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = BIT(7), 1417 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8), 1418 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9), 1419 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10), 1420 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11), 1421 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12), 1422 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13), 1423 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14), 1424 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15), 1425 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = BIT(16), 1426 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(17), 1427 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18), 1428 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19), 1429 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA = BIT(20), 1430 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21), 1431 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22), 1432 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23), 1433 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24), 1434 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25), 1435 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26), 1436 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27), 1437 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28), 1438 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29), 1439 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30), 1440 }; 1441 1442 /** 1443 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags 1444 * 1445 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame 1446 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used 1447 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission, 1448 * if the driver fills this value it should add 1449 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT 1450 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact. 1451 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used 1452 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3 1453 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed 1454 */ 1455 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags { 1456 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0), 1457 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1458 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3), 1459 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5), 1460 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6), 1461 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7), 1462 }; 1463 1464 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4 1465 1466 enum mac80211_rx_encoding { 1467 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0, 1468 RX_ENC_HT, 1469 RX_ENC_VHT, 1470 RX_ENC_HE, 1471 RX_ENC_EHT, 1472 }; 1473 1474 /** 1475 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status 1476 * 1477 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset 1478 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received 1479 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb). 1480 * 1481 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function 1482 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware. 1483 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is 1484 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache. 1485 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only 1486 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames. 1487 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1488 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use 1489 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation 1490 * @band: the active band when this frame was received 1491 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz 1492 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed 1493 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting. 1494 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz. 1495 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or 1496 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags 1497 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_* 1498 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength 1499 * values were filled. 1500 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't 1501 * support dB or unspecified units) 1502 * @antenna: antenna used 1503 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if 1504 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT) 1505 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only) 1506 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\* 1507 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding 1508 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw 1509 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags 1510 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc 1511 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi 1512 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1513 * @eht: EHT specific rate information 1514 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc 1515 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi 1516 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211 1517 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for 1518 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU 1519 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC 1520 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU 1521 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag 1522 * is set only when connection is MLO. 1523 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with 1524 * @link_valid. 1525 */ 1526 struct ieee80211_rx_status { 1527 u64 mactime; 1528 union { 1529 u64 boottime_ns; 1530 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp; 1531 }; 1532 u32 device_timestamp; 1533 u32 ampdu_reference; 1534 u32 flag; 1535 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1; 1536 u8 enc_flags; 1537 u8 encoding:3, bw:4; 1538 union { 1539 struct { 1540 u8 he_ru:3; 1541 u8 he_gi:2; 1542 u8 he_dcm:1; 1543 }; 1544 struct { 1545 u8 ru:4; 1546 u8 gi:2; 1547 } eht; 1548 }; 1549 u8 rate_idx; 1550 u8 nss; 1551 u8 rx_flags; 1552 u8 band; 1553 u8 antenna; 1554 s8 signal; 1555 u8 chains; 1556 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1557 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc; 1558 u8 zero_length_psdu_type; 1559 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4; 1560 }; 1561 1562 static inline u32 1563 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status) 1564 { 1565 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) + 1566 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0); 1567 } 1568 1569 /** 1570 * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information 1571 * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace 1572 * (this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more 1573 * bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that) 1574 * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed 1575 * alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace 1576 * description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment) 1577 * Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1! 1578 * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI 1579 * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace 1580 * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done 1581 * then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the 1582 * @data field. 1583 * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that 1584 * the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd 1585 * length 1586 * @data: the actual vendor namespace data 1587 * 1588 * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before 1589 * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns 1590 * data. 1591 */ 1592 struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap { 1593 u32 present; 1594 u8 align; 1595 u8 oui[3]; 1596 u8 subns; 1597 u8 pad; 1598 u16 len; 1599 u8 data[]; 1600 } __packed; 1601 1602 /** 1603 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags 1604 * 1605 * Flags to define PHY configuration options 1606 * 1607 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this 1608 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets 1609 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags! 1610 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only). 1611 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2, 1612 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to 1613 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames. 1614 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states, 1615 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support" 1616 * for more. 1617 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set 1618 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but 1619 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will 1620 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but 1621 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active. 1622 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main 1623 * operating channel. 1624 */ 1625 enum ieee80211_conf_flags { 1626 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0), 1627 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1), 1628 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2), 1629 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3), 1630 }; 1631 1632 1633 /** 1634 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed 1635 * 1636 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed 1637 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed 1638 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed 1639 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed 1640 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed 1641 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed 1642 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed 1643 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed 1644 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1645 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1646 */ 1647 enum ieee80211_conf_changed { 1648 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1), 1649 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2), 1650 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3), 1651 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4), 1652 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5), 1653 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6), 1654 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7), 1655 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8), 1656 }; 1657 1658 /** 1659 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode 1660 * 1661 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic 1662 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off 1663 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static 1664 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic 1665 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use 1666 */ 1667 enum ieee80211_smps_mode { 1668 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC, 1669 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF, 1670 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC, 1671 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, 1672 1673 /* keep last */ 1674 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES, 1675 }; 1676 1677 /** 1678 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device 1679 * 1680 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware. 1681 * 1682 * @flags: configuration flags defined above 1683 * 1684 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval 1685 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use 1686 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon 1687 * has been received and the DTIM period is known. 1688 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the 1689 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when 1690 * the CONF_PS flag is set. 1691 * 1692 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility 1693 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces 1694 * 1695 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to 1696 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled 1697 * 1698 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame 1699 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11, 1700 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries 1701 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short" 1702 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the 1703 * number of transmissions not the number of retries 1704 * 1705 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that 1706 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not 1707 * configured for an HT channel. 1708 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1709 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1710 */ 1711 struct ieee80211_conf { 1712 u32 flags; 1713 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout; 1714 1715 u16 listen_interval; 1716 u8 ps_dtim_period; 1717 1718 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count; 1719 1720 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1721 bool radar_enabled; 1722 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1723 }; 1724 1725 /** 1726 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data 1727 * 1728 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch 1729 * operation. 1730 * 1731 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization 1732 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch 1733 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter 1734 * the driver passed into mac80211. 1735 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the 1736 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211. 1737 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the 1738 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP. 1739 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to 1740 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event 1741 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in 1742 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new 1743 * channel, expressed in TU. 1744 */ 1745 struct ieee80211_channel_switch { 1746 u64 timestamp; 1747 u32 device_timestamp; 1748 bool block_tx; 1749 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1750 u8 count; 1751 u32 delay; 1752 }; 1753 1754 /** 1755 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags 1756 * 1757 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering 1758 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups 1759 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality 1760 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor 1761 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and 1762 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached. 1763 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this 1764 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition, 1765 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is 1766 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces. 1767 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes 1768 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even 1769 * this is not pure P2P vif. 1770 */ 1771 enum ieee80211_vif_flags { 1772 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0), 1773 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1), 1774 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2), 1775 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3), 1776 }; 1777 1778 1779 /** 1780 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags 1781 * 1782 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled 1783 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211. 1784 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface. 1785 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload 1786 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled 1787 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to 1788 * mac80211. 1789 */ 1790 1791 enum ieee80211_offload_flags { 1792 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0), 1793 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1), 1794 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2), 1795 }; 1796 1797 /** 1798 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration 1799 * @assoc: association status 1800 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not 1801 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created 1802 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by 1803 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations. 1804 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true 1805 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The 1806 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here. 1807 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here 1808 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass. 1809 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this 1810 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list 1811 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case. 1812 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode. 1813 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid. 1814 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format). 1815 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the 1816 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what 1817 * your driver/device needs to do. 1818 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections 1819 * (station mode only) 1820 */ 1821 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg { 1822 /* association related data */ 1823 bool assoc, ibss_joined; 1824 bool ibss_creator; 1825 bool ps; 1826 u16 aid; 1827 1828 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN]; 1829 int arp_addr_cnt; 1830 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 1831 size_t ssid_len; 1832 bool s1g; 1833 bool idle; 1834 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1835 }; 1836 1837 /** 1838 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data 1839 * 1840 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver 1841 * use during the life of a virtual interface. 1842 * 1843 * @type: type of this virtual interface 1844 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg 1845 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own 1846 * or the BSS we're associated to 1847 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration, 1848 * indexed by link ID 1849 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1850 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1851 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the 1852 * API calls meant for that purpose. 1853 * @addr: address of this interface 1854 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p 1855 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively 1856 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this 1857 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver 1858 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup 1859 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM) 1860 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface, 1861 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added 1862 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed 1863 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field 1864 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface. 1865 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface, 1866 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver 1867 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change 1868 * restrictions. 1869 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC 1870 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only 1871 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per 1872 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual 1873 * monitor interface (if that is requested.) 1874 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this 1875 * interface. 1876 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211 1877 * for this interface. 1878 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 1879 * sizeof(void \*). 1880 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue 1881 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see 1882 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags. 1883 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled. 1884 */ 1885 struct ieee80211_vif { 1886 enum nl80211_iftype type; 1887 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg; 1888 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf; 1889 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 1890 u16 valid_links, active_links; 1891 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1892 bool p2p; 1893 1894 u8 cab_queue; 1895 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS]; 1896 1897 struct ieee80211_txq *txq; 1898 1899 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 1900 u32 driver_flags; 1901 u32 offload_flags; 1902 1903 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 1904 struct dentry *debugfs_dir; 1905 #endif 1906 1907 bool probe_req_reg; 1908 bool rx_mcast_action_reg; 1909 1910 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif; 1911 1912 /* must be last */ 1913 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 1914 }; 1915 1916 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \ 1917 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \ 1918 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 1919 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 1920 (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id]))) 1921 1922 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1923 { 1924 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH 1925 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT; 1926 #endif 1927 return false; 1928 } 1929 1930 /** 1931 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev 1932 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for 1933 * 1934 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 1935 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev. 1936 * 1937 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't 1938 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor 1939 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.) 1940 */ 1941 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 1942 1943 /** 1944 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif 1945 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for 1946 * 1947 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 1948 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif. 1949 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif. 1950 */ 1951 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 1952 1953 /** 1954 * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners 1955 * @vif: the interface to check 1956 */ 1957 static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1958 { 1959 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx); 1960 } 1961 1962 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \ 1963 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 1964 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif)) 1965 1966 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \ 1967 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 1968 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif)) 1969 1970 /** 1971 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags 1972 * 1973 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver 1974 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf. 1975 * 1976 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the 1977 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this 1978 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs 1979 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC. 1980 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by 1981 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC 1982 * generation in software. 1983 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates 1984 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key. 1985 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a 1986 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames 1987 * (MFP) to be done in software. 1988 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver 1989 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV 1990 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with 1991 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does 1992 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or 1993 * MIC. 1994 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received 1995 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware 1996 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames 1997 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and 1998 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with 1999 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the 2000 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW. 2001 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the 2002 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation 2003 * only for management frames (MFP). 2004 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the 2005 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always 2006 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled. 2007 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for 2008 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with 2009 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key. 2010 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation. 2011 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver 2012 * for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number 2013 * generation only 2014 */ 2015 enum ieee80211_key_flags { 2016 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0), 2017 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1), 2018 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2), 2019 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3), 2020 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4), 2021 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5), 2022 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6), 2023 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7), 2024 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8), 2025 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9), 2026 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10), 2027 }; 2028 2029 /** 2030 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information 2031 * 2032 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by 2033 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops. 2034 * 2035 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver 2036 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be 2037 * encrypted in hardware. 2038 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector. 2039 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it 2040 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO) 2041 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags. 2042 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3) 2043 * @keylen: key material length 2044 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte) 2045 * data block: 2046 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits) 2047 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits) 2048 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits) 2049 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type 2050 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type 2051 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys 2052 */ 2053 struct ieee80211_key_conf { 2054 atomic64_t tx_pn; 2055 u32 cipher; 2056 u8 icv_len; 2057 u8 iv_len; 2058 u8 hw_key_idx; 2059 s8 keyidx; 2060 u16 flags; 2061 s8 link_id; 2062 u8 keylen; 2063 u8 key[]; 2064 }; 2065 2066 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16 2067 2068 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff)) 2069 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff)) 2070 2071 /** 2072 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter 2073 * 2074 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order 2075 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2076 * reverse order than in packet) 2077 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2078 * reverse order than in packet) 2079 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2080 * reverse order than in packet) 2081 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2082 * reverse order than in packet) 2083 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys 2084 */ 2085 struct ieee80211_key_seq { 2086 union { 2087 struct { 2088 u32 iv32; 2089 u16 iv16; 2090 } tkip; 2091 struct { 2092 u8 pn[6]; 2093 } ccmp; 2094 struct { 2095 u8 pn[6]; 2096 } aes_cmac; 2097 struct { 2098 u8 pn[6]; 2099 } aes_gmac; 2100 struct { 2101 u8 pn[6]; 2102 } gcmp; 2103 struct { 2104 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN]; 2105 u8 seq_len; 2106 } hw; 2107 }; 2108 }; 2109 2110 /** 2111 * enum set_key_cmd - key command 2112 * 2113 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2114 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added. 2115 * 2116 * @SET_KEY: a key is set 2117 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled 2118 */ 2119 enum set_key_cmd { 2120 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY, 2121 }; 2122 2123 /** 2124 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state 2125 * 2126 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all, 2127 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions 2128 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state 2129 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated 2130 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated 2131 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) 2132 */ 2133 enum ieee80211_sta_state { 2134 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */ 2135 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST, 2136 IEEE80211_STA_NONE, 2137 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH, 2138 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC, 2139 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED, 2140 }; 2141 2142 /** 2143 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth 2144 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz 2145 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz 2146 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz 2147 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz 2148 * (including 80+80 MHz) 2149 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz 2150 * 2151 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized 2152 * correctly, the values must be sorted. 2153 */ 2154 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth { 2155 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0, 2156 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40, 2157 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80, 2158 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160, 2159 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320, 2160 }; 2161 2162 /** 2163 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table 2164 * 2165 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update 2166 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default. 2167 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control. 2168 */ 2169 struct ieee80211_sta_rates { 2170 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2171 struct { 2172 s8 idx; 2173 u8 count; 2174 u8 count_cts; 2175 u8 count_rts; 2176 u16 flags; 2177 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE]; 2178 }; 2179 2180 /** 2181 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 2182 * 2183 * Used to configure txpower for station. 2184 * 2185 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames 2186 * to the STA. 2187 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 2188 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 2189 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 2190 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 2191 * per peer TPC. 2192 */ 2193 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr { 2194 s16 power; 2195 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 2196 }; 2197 2198 /** 2199 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links 2200 * 2201 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the 2202 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change. 2203 * 2204 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes. 2205 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble. 2206 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply: 2207 * 2208 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the 2209 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes. 2210 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal 2211 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes. 2212 * 2213 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level 2214 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section 2215 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2). 2216 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control. 2217 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID 2218 */ 2219 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates { 2220 u16 max_amsdu_len; 2221 2222 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len; 2223 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS]; 2224 }; 2225 2226 /** 2227 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info 2228 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single) 2229 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here. 2230 * 2231 * @sta: reference to owning STA 2232 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr 2233 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different 2234 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr) 2235 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink) 2236 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic) 2237 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates 2238 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2239 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2240 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA 2241 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities 2242 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA 2243 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with 2244 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the 2245 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode 2246 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after 2247 * the station moves to associated state. 2248 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration 2249 * 2250 */ 2251 struct ieee80211_link_sta { 2252 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2253 2254 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2255 u8 link_id; 2256 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 2257 2258 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2259 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 2260 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 2261 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 2262 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 2263 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; 2264 2265 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg; 2266 2267 u8 rx_nss; 2268 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth; 2269 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr; 2270 }; 2271 2272 /** 2273 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry 2274 * 2275 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly 2276 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in 2277 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must 2278 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly, 2279 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a 2280 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it. 2281 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association 2282 * and holds pointers to various link STA's 2283 * 2284 * @addr: MAC address 2285 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP 2286 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU 2287 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us. 2288 * Can be modified by driver. 2289 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does, 2290 * otherwise always false) 2291 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 2292 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information. 2293 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid 2294 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in 2295 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*. 2296 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported. 2297 * @rates: rate control selection table 2298 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer 2299 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only 2300 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place. 2301 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not. 2302 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station. 2303 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single 2304 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means 2305 * unlimited. 2306 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links 2307 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA 2308 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it. 2309 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not. 2310 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) 2311 * is used for non-data frames 2312 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link 2313 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through 2314 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA 2315 * the first added link STA will point to deflink. 2316 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link, 2317 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and 2318 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO 2319 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to 2320 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address 2321 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned 2322 * by the AP. 2323 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO 2324 */ 2325 struct ieee80211_sta { 2326 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2327 u16 aid; 2328 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2329 bool wme; 2330 u8 uapsd_queues; 2331 u8 max_sp; 2332 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates; 2333 bool tdls; 2334 bool tdls_initiator; 2335 bool mfp; 2336 bool mlo; 2337 u8 max_amsdu_subframes; 2338 2339 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur; 2340 2341 bool support_p2p_ps; 2342 2343 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1]; 2344 2345 u16 valid_links; 2346 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink; 2347 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 2348 2349 /* must be last */ 2350 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2351 }; 2352 2353 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP 2354 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 2355 #else 2356 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta) 2357 { 2358 return true; 2359 } 2360 #endif 2361 2362 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \ 2363 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2364 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2365 2366 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \ 2367 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2368 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2369 2370 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \ 2371 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \ 2372 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 2373 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 2374 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id))) 2375 2376 /** 2377 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command 2378 * 2379 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2380 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition. 2381 * 2382 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping 2383 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up 2384 */ 2385 enum sta_notify_cmd { 2386 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE, 2387 }; 2388 2389 /** 2390 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data 2391 * 2392 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and 2393 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU. 2394 */ 2395 struct ieee80211_tx_control { 2396 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2397 }; 2398 2399 /** 2400 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue 2401 * 2402 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 2403 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue 2404 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue), 2405 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled) 2406 * @ac: the AC for this queue 2407 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size 2408 * 2409 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling 2410 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). 2411 */ 2412 struct ieee80211_txq { 2413 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 2414 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2415 u8 tid; 2416 u8 ac; 2417 2418 /* must be last */ 2419 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2420 }; 2421 2422 /** 2423 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags 2424 * 2425 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to 2426 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning 2427 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting 2428 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule, 2429 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully. 2430 * 2431 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL: 2432 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be 2433 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm 2434 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace 2435 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control 2436 * algorithm. 2437 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of 2438 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have 2439 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config 2440 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot 2441 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for 2442 * CCK frames. 2443 * 2444 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS: 2445 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include 2446 * the FCS at the end. 2447 * 2448 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING: 2449 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames 2450 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others 2451 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used 2452 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and 2453 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that 2454 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(). 2455 * 2456 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: 2457 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We 2458 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal. 2459 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead. 2460 * 2461 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM: 2462 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from 2463 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized 2464 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set. 2465 * 2466 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT: 2467 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h 2468 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC 2469 * 2470 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION: 2471 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation. 2472 * 2473 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS: 2474 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep). 2475 * 2476 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK: 2477 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies 2478 * stack support for dynamic PS. 2479 * 2480 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS: 2481 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS. 2482 * 2483 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE: 2484 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w). 2485 * 2486 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS: 2487 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to 2488 * the stack. 2489 * 2490 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR: 2491 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including 2492 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss. 2493 * 2494 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC: 2495 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e. 2496 * dtim_period). 2497 * 2498 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports 2499 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If 2500 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not 2501 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still 2502 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag 2503 * only in that case. 2504 * 2505 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device 2506 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When 2507 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected 2508 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames. 2509 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure 2510 * the PS mode of connected stations. 2511 * 2512 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session 2513 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in 2514 * software. 2515 * 2516 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of 2517 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only 2518 * active interfaces. 2519 * 2520 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to 2521 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as 2522 * desired (and thus have them named as desired). 2523 * 2524 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the 2525 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically 2526 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if 2527 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its 2528 * supported cipher suites. 2529 * 2530 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit, 2531 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration 2532 * for frames. 2533 * 2534 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface 2535 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC) 2536 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue 2537 * control for more details. 2538 * 2539 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate 2540 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm. 2541 * 2542 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any 2543 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface 2544 * is supported. 2545 * 2546 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames 2547 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon. 2548 * 2549 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates 2550 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not 2551 * using aggregation for such frames.) 2552 * 2553 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA) 2554 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support 2555 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the 2556 * CSA frame. 2557 * 2558 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload 2559 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first. 2560 * 2561 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands 2562 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band. 2563 * 2564 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth 2565 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel. 2566 * 2567 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs 2568 * within A-MPDU. 2569 * 2570 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status 2571 * for sent beacons. 2572 * 2573 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each 2574 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified 2575 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station 2576 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time. 2577 * 2578 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the 2579 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in 2580 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session 2581 * timeout. 2582 * 2583 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX, 2584 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics. 2585 * 2586 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated 2587 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support. 2588 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must 2589 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting 2590 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta. 2591 * 2592 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list 2593 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU. 2594 * 2595 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event 2596 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such 2597 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver 2598 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout. 2599 * 2600 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself. 2601 * The stack will not do fragmentation. 2602 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well. 2603 * 2604 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on 2605 * TDLS links. 2606 * 2607 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the 2608 * mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a 2609 * deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no 2610 * beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the 2611 * virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of 2612 * the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the 2613 * deauthentication frame might not be transmitted. 2614 * 2615 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't 2616 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug. 2617 * 2618 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of 2619 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with. 2620 * 2621 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT 2622 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if 2623 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW 2624 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver. 2625 * See also the documentation for that flag. 2626 * 2627 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all 2628 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use 2629 * TXQs to start with. 2630 * 2631 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU 2632 * length in tx status information 2633 * 2634 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2635 * 2636 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2637 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set. 2638 * 2639 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only 2640 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx 2641 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID. 2642 * 2643 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation 2644 * offload 2645 * 2646 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation 2647 * offload 2648 * 2649 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx 2650 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface. 2651 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real 2652 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to 2653 * the stack. 2654 * 2655 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color 2656 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software. 2657 * 2658 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting 2659 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that. 2660 * 2661 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays 2662 */ 2663 enum ieee80211_hw_flags { 2664 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL, 2665 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS, 2666 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING, 2667 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC, 2668 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM, 2669 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC, 2670 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT, 2671 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION, 2672 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS, 2673 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK, 2674 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS, 2675 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE, 2676 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF, 2677 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF, 2678 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL, 2679 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT, 2680 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS, 2681 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR, 2682 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL, 2683 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK, 2684 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, 2685 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW, 2686 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE, 2687 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF, 2688 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY, 2689 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES, 2690 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA, 2691 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS, 2692 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS, 2693 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW, 2694 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU, 2695 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS, 2696 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR, 2697 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER, 2698 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS, 2699 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU, 2700 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST, 2701 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK, 2702 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG, 2703 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA, 2704 IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, 2705 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP, 2706 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ, 2707 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW, 2708 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ, 2709 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN, 2710 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID, 2711 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID, 2712 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT, 2713 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD, 2714 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD, 2715 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP, 2716 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION, 2717 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX, 2718 2719 /* keep last, obviously */ 2720 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS 2721 }; 2722 2723 /** 2724 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state 2725 * 2726 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware 2727 * information for an 802.11 PHY. 2728 * 2729 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this 2730 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev 2731 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV() 2732 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported 2733 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here. 2734 * 2735 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use. 2736 * 2737 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use 2738 * along with this structure. 2739 * 2740 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags. 2741 * 2742 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb 2743 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.) 2744 * 2745 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb. 2746 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs. 2747 * 2748 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used 2749 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB 2750 * 2751 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval 2752 * that HW supports 2753 * 2754 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for 2755 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these 2756 * queues need to have configurable access parameters. 2757 * 2758 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware. 2759 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be 2760 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw(). 2761 * 2762 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2763 * within &struct ieee80211_vif. 2764 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2765 * within &struct ieee80211_sta. 2766 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2767 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf. 2768 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2769 * within @struct ieee80211_txq. 2770 * 2771 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw 2772 * can handle. 2773 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages 2774 * the hw can report back. 2775 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage 2776 * 2777 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of 2778 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver 2779 * aggregation. 2780 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the 2781 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering 2782 * it shouldn't be set. 2783 * 2784 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an 2785 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll 2786 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if 2787 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N 2788 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012). 2789 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used. 2790 * 2791 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum 2792 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list. 2793 * 2794 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX 2795 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set) 2796 * 2797 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW 2798 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't 2799 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only 2800 * adding _BW is supported today. 2801 * 2802 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports, 2803 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH. 2804 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values. 2805 * 2806 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags 2807 * 2808 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the 2809 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp 2810 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status 2811 * device_timestamp. 2812 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a 2813 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a 2814 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value. 2815 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the 2816 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set. 2817 * 2818 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created 2819 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211, 2820 * other features will be rejected during HW registration. 2821 * 2822 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate 2823 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery- 2824 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap. 2825 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means 2826 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means 2827 * neither enabled. 2828 * 2829 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may 2830 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA. 2831 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values. 2832 * 2833 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the 2834 * device. 2835 * 2836 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from 2837 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed, 2838 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers. 2839 * 2840 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while 2841 * refilling deficit of each TXQ. 2842 * 2843 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set. 2844 * 2845 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware. 2846 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions. 2847 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level. 2848 * 2849 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list. 2850 */ 2851 struct ieee80211_hw { 2852 struct ieee80211_conf conf; 2853 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2854 const char *rate_control_algorithm; 2855 void *priv; 2856 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)]; 2857 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom; 2858 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom; 2859 int vif_data_size; 2860 int sta_data_size; 2861 int chanctx_data_size; 2862 int txq_data_size; 2863 u16 queues; 2864 u16 max_listen_interval; 2865 s8 max_signal; 2866 u8 max_rates; 2867 u8 max_report_rates; 2868 u8 max_rate_tries; 2869 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2870 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes; 2871 u8 max_tx_fragments; 2872 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue; 2873 u8 radiotap_mcs_details; 2874 u16 radiotap_vht_details; 2875 struct { 2876 int units_pos; 2877 s16 accuracy; 2878 } radiotap_timestamp; 2879 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 2880 u8 uapsd_queues; 2881 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len; 2882 u8 max_nan_de_entries; 2883 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift; 2884 u8 weight_multiplier; 2885 u32 max_mtu; 2886 const s8 *tx_power_levels; 2887 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx; 2888 }; 2889 2890 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2891 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2892 { 2893 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2894 } 2895 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2896 2897 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2898 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2899 { 2900 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2901 } 2902 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2903 2904 /** 2905 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request 2906 * 2907 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie) 2908 * @req: cfg80211 request. 2909 */ 2910 struct ieee80211_scan_request { 2911 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies; 2912 2913 /* Keep last */ 2914 struct cfg80211_scan_request req; 2915 }; 2916 2917 /** 2918 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters 2919 * 2920 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from 2921 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request 2922 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode 2923 * @status: channel-switch response status 2924 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received 2925 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 2926 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 2927 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template 2928 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb 2929 */ 2930 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params { 2931 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2932 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef; 2933 u8 action_code; 2934 u32 status; 2935 u32 timestamp; 2936 u16 switch_time; 2937 u16 switch_timeout; 2938 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb; 2939 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie; 2940 }; 2941 2942 /** 2943 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy 2944 * 2945 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query 2946 * 2947 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective 2948 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private 2949 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should 2950 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this 2951 * is already used internally by mac80211. 2952 * 2953 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy. 2954 */ 2955 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy); 2956 2957 /** 2958 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware 2959 * 2960 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for 2961 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 2962 */ 2963 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev) 2964 { 2965 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev); 2966 } 2967 2968 /** 2969 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware 2970 * 2971 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for 2972 * @addr: the address to set 2973 */ 2974 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr) 2975 { 2976 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN); 2977 } 2978 2979 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 2980 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2981 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 2982 { 2983 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0)) 2984 return NULL; 2985 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx]; 2986 } 2987 2988 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 2989 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2990 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 2991 { 2992 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0) 2993 return NULL; 2994 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx]; 2995 } 2996 2997 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 2998 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2999 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx) 3000 { 3001 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0) 3002 return NULL; 3003 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx]; 3004 } 3005 3006 /** 3007 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb 3008 * @hw: the hardware 3009 * @skb: the skb 3010 * 3011 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure 3012 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported. 3013 */ 3014 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 3015 3016 /** 3017 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration 3018 * 3019 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware 3020 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations. 3021 * 3022 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given 3023 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and 3024 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL 3025 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to 3026 * the station information for the peer for individual keys. 3027 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when 3028 * VLANs are configured for an access point. 3029 * 3030 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx 3031 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf 3032 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function. 3033 * 3034 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if 3035 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be 3036 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the 3037 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range. 3038 * 3039 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is 3040 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if 3041 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the 3042 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software. 3043 * 3044 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed. 3045 * 3046 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key 3047 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any 3048 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather 3049 * based on the receive flags. 3050 * 3051 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key 3052 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key() 3053 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate 3054 * keys. 3055 * 3056 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption 3057 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key 3058 * handler. 3059 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key. 3060 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The 3061 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did 3062 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is 3063 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this 3064 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16. 3065 * 3066 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index 3067 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required 3068 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses). 3069 * 3070 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag 3071 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following 3072 * requirements: 3073 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211 3074 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed, 3075 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued 3076 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits), 3077 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command 3078 encrypted with the new key when also needing 3079 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and 3080 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted. 3081 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver. 3082 */ 3083 3084 /** 3085 * DOC: Powersave support 3086 * 3087 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations. 3088 * 3089 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself, 3090 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware 3091 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode 3092 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status. 3093 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary, 3094 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required 3095 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when 3096 * it finds traffic directed to it. 3097 * 3098 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in 3099 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused 3100 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking 3101 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it 3102 * back to sleep at appropriate times. 3103 * 3104 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the 3105 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be 3106 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame. 3107 * 3108 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also 3109 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported 3110 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and 3111 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still 3112 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle 3113 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that 3114 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that. 3115 * 3116 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the 3117 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a 3118 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to 3119 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when 3120 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle 3121 * periods. 3122 * 3123 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling 3124 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS 3125 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally, 3126 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the 3127 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support 3128 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the 3129 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value 3130 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable 3131 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS 3132 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave. 3133 * 3134 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling 3135 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the 3136 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS 3137 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To 3138 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames 3139 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled. 3140 * 3141 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with 3142 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK. 3143 */ 3144 3145 /** 3146 * DOC: Beacon filter support 3147 * 3148 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups 3149 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that 3150 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly 3151 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the 3152 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That 3153 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information 3154 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed. 3155 * 3156 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER 3157 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support 3158 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When 3159 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the 3160 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss(). 3161 * 3162 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the 3163 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call 3164 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled 3165 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future. 3166 * 3167 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing 3168 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211 3169 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense 3170 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include 3171 * 3172 * - a list of information element IDs 3173 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element 3174 * 3175 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the 3176 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense 3177 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device 3178 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all 3179 * vendor information elements. 3180 * 3181 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information 3182 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon. 3183 * 3184 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing 3185 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing 3186 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and 3187 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136, 3188 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility 3189 * it could also include some currently unused IDs. 3190 * 3191 * 3192 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the 3193 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming 3194 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of 3195 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when 3196 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above 3197 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be 3198 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement 3199 * them as the roaming algorithm requires. 3200 * 3201 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to 3202 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the 3203 * signal strength threshold checking. 3204 */ 3205 3206 /** 3207 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save 3208 * 3209 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve 3210 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism 3211 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009) 3212 * "11.2.3 SM power save". 3213 * 3214 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames 3215 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct 3216 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the 3217 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware 3218 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by 3219 * hardware flags. 3220 * 3221 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211 3222 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS 3223 * turned off otherwise. 3224 * 3225 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate 3226 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config() 3227 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to 3228 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP. 3229 */ 3230 3231 /** 3232 * DOC: Frame filtering 3233 * 3234 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper 3235 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when 3236 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption, 3237 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is 3238 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible. 3239 * 3240 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell 3241 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be 3242 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out. 3243 * 3244 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast() 3245 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list 3246 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces. 3247 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to 3248 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the 3249 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and 3250 * @total_flags with the new flag states. 3251 * 3252 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will 3253 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count 3254 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted 3255 * or dropped. 3256 * 3257 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared. 3258 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_ 3259 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore 3260 * the flag, but not clear it. 3261 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the 3262 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type 3263 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it). 3264 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware 3265 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes 3266 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them, 3267 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag. 3268 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well. 3269 */ 3270 3271 /** 3272 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients 3273 * 3274 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for 3275 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD. 3276 * There currently is no support for sAPSD. 3277 * 3278 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client 3279 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time. 3280 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but 3281 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies 3282 * the driver code. 3283 * 3284 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete 3285 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set, 3286 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for 3287 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames. 3288 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of 3289 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't 3290 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD. 3291 * 3292 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the 3293 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a 3294 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is, 3295 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is 3296 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this 3297 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to 3298 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will 3299 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The 3300 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its 3301 * @sta_notify callback. 3302 * 3303 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up, 3304 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period. 3305 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and 3306 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When 3307 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211 3308 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames 3309 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit 3310 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER 3311 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only 3312 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to 3313 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have 3314 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS. 3315 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is 3316 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer. 3317 * 3318 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by 3319 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them. 3320 * 3321 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi 3322 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up 3323 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being 3324 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong 3325 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be 3326 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to 3327 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can 3328 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it 3329 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames 3330 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again 3331 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked. 3332 * 3333 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any 3334 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is 3335 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any 3336 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up 3337 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when 3338 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service 3339 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called 3340 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are 3341 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting 3342 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames, 3343 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if 3344 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames 3345 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the 3346 * buffers for those TIDs contain. 3347 * 3348 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may 3349 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must 3350 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that 3351 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid 3352 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released 3353 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp() 3354 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway. 3355 * 3356 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211 3357 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags 3358 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 3359 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame. 3360 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case. 3361 * 3362 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data 3363 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as 3364 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame 3365 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed. 3366 */ 3367 3368 /** 3369 * DOC: HW queue control 3370 * 3371 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static 3372 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This 3373 * was problematic for a few reasons: 3374 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames 3375 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly 3376 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames 3377 * 3378 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all 3379 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it 3380 * won't have the same problem with the software queues. 3381 * 3382 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability 3383 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do 3384 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif 3385 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will 3386 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and 3387 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors 3388 * the hardware queue. 3389 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue 3390 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.) 3391 * 3392 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual 3393 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to 3394 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a 3395 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have 3396 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios: 3397 * 3398 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3 3399 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7 3400 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8 3401 * off-channel queue: 9 3402 * 3403 * It would then set up the hardware like this: 3404 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9 3405 * 3406 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows: 3407 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0 3408 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1 3409 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2 3410 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3 3411 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3412 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7. 3413 * 3414 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second 3415 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC. 3416 * 3417 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3418 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the 3419 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when 3420 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode. 3421 */ 3422 3423 /** 3424 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags 3425 * 3426 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be 3427 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the 3428 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested, 3429 * but this has negative impact on power consumption. 3430 * 3431 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested 3432 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by 3433 * multicast address. 3434 * 3435 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the 3436 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them) 3437 * 3438 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set 3439 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them 3440 * 3441 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate 3442 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses 3443 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing 3444 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should 3445 * honour this flag if possible. 3446 * 3447 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this 3448 * station 3449 * 3450 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes 3451 * 3452 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames 3453 * 3454 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames 3455 * 3456 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames 3457 */ 3458 enum ieee80211_filter_flags { 3459 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1, 3460 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2, 3461 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3, 3462 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4, 3463 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5, 3464 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6, 3465 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7, 3466 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8, 3467 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9, 3468 }; 3469 3470 /** 3471 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions 3472 * 3473 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in 3474 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed. 3475 * 3476 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation 3477 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by 3478 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer 3479 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away! 3480 * 3481 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation 3482 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation 3483 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either 3484 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or 3485 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status 3486 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after 3487 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special 3488 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE. 3489 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational 3490 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting 3491 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the 3492 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(). 3493 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets, 3494 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call 3495 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the 3496 * session is gone and removes the station. 3497 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped 3498 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and 3499 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers 3500 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called. 3501 */ 3502 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action { 3503 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START, 3504 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP, 3505 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START, 3506 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT, 3507 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH, 3508 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT, 3509 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL, 3510 }; 3511 3512 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1 3513 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2 3514 3515 /** 3516 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters 3517 * 3518 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 3519 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session 3520 * @tid: tid of the BA session 3521 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When 3522 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the 3523 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here. 3524 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the 3525 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or 3526 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3527 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU. 3528 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3529 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to 3530 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START 3531 */ 3532 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params { 3533 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action; 3534 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 3535 u16 tid; 3536 u16 ssn; 3537 u16 buf_size; 3538 bool amsdu; 3539 u16 timeout; 3540 }; 3541 3542 /** 3543 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason 3544 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll 3545 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to 3546 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC 3547 */ 3548 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type { 3549 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL, 3550 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD, 3551 }; 3552 3553 /** 3554 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed 3555 * 3556 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit 3557 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station 3558 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40 3559 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes. 3560 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed. 3561 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer 3562 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about 3563 * the peer. 3564 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed 3565 * by the peer 3566 */ 3567 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed { 3568 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 3569 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1), 3570 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2), 3571 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3), 3572 }; 3573 3574 /** 3575 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type 3576 * 3577 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations, 3578 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other 3579 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa). 3580 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC 3581 * operations compared to other operations/flows. 3582 * 3583 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC. 3584 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required 3585 * for sending management frames offchannel. 3586 */ 3587 enum ieee80211_roc_type { 3588 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0, 3589 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX, 3590 }; 3591 3592 /** 3593 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type 3594 * 3595 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what 3596 * reconfiguration type was completed. 3597 * 3598 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type 3599 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1) 3600 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless 3601 * of wowlan configuration) 3602 */ 3603 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type { 3604 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART, 3605 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND, 3606 }; 3607 3608 /** 3609 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information 3610 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration, 3611 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method. 3612 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc) 3613 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only 3614 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only 3615 * valid for auth and (re)assoc. 3616 */ 3617 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info { 3618 u16 duration; 3619 u16 subtype; 3620 u8 success:1; 3621 }; 3622 3623 /** 3624 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver 3625 * 3626 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may 3627 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure 3628 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame. 3629 * 3630 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame. 3631 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header. 3632 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on 3633 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should, 3634 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately. 3635 * Must be atomic. 3636 * 3637 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware 3638 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on 3639 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.) 3640 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace, 3641 * or zero. 3642 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address 3643 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device 3644 * is added. 3645 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3646 * 3647 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware 3648 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least 3649 * it must turn off frame reception.) 3650 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects 3651 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue 3652 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback. 3653 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3654 * 3655 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and 3656 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then 3657 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is 3658 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and 3659 * reconfigured at resume time. 3660 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it 3661 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only 3662 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it 3663 * must return 1 from this function. 3664 * 3665 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is 3666 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully 3667 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is 3668 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211 3669 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume. 3670 * 3671 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is 3672 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is 3673 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only 3674 * in suspend(). 3675 * 3676 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is 3677 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start 3678 * and @stop must be implemented. 3679 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before 3680 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the 3681 * interface is given in the conf parameter. 3682 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a 3683 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.) 3684 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3685 * 3686 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback 3687 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be 3688 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep. 3689 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be 3690 * found by the interface iteration callbacks. 3691 * 3692 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down. 3693 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface 3694 * and no monitor interfaces are present. 3695 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware 3696 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets, 3697 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the 3698 * MAC address of the device going away. 3699 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep. 3700 * 3701 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this 3702 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel. 3703 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code 3704 * if it does. The callback can sleep. 3705 * 3706 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS 3707 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low 3708 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters). 3709 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless 3710 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which 3711 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback 3712 * can sleep. 3713 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed 3714 * are not implemented. 3715 * 3716 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface 3717 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the 3718 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.) 3719 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed. 3720 * The callback can sleep. 3721 * 3722 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link 3723 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an 3724 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information. 3725 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id 3726 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for 3727 * non-MLO connections. 3728 * The callback can sleep. 3729 * 3730 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration. 3731 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed 3732 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic. 3733 * 3734 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter. 3735 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information. 3736 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep. 3737 * 3738 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter. 3739 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames 3740 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination 3741 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates 3742 * which flags are changed. 3743 * This callback can sleep. 3744 * 3745 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit 3746 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic. 3747 * 3748 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3749 * This callback is only called between add_interface and 3750 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface 3751 * is enabled. 3752 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added. 3753 * The callback can sleep. 3754 * 3755 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3756 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers 3757 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY. 3758 * The callback must be atomic. 3759 * 3760 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the 3761 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data 3762 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter. 3763 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify 3764 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(). 3765 * 3766 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for 3767 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP 3768 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it. 3769 * 3770 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start 3771 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel 3772 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's 3773 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure 3774 * that power save is disabled. 3775 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the 3776 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these 3777 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the 3778 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable). 3779 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called; 3780 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to 3781 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code. 3782 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1, 3783 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a 3784 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this 3785 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't 3786 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is. 3787 * The callback can sleep. 3788 * 3789 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan. 3790 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible), 3791 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call 3792 * ieee80211_scan_completed(). 3793 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new 3794 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended. 3795 * The callback can sleep. 3796 * 3797 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at 3798 * specific intervals. The driver must call the 3799 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results. 3800 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called. 3801 * 3802 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan. 3803 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called. 3804 * 3805 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan 3806 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification. 3807 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR, 3808 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it 3809 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep. 3810 * 3811 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a 3812 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need 3813 * this notification. 3814 * The callback can sleep. 3815 * 3816 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics. 3817 * Returns zero if statistics are available. 3818 * The callback can sleep. 3819 * 3820 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does 3821 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the 3822 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware. 3823 * The callback must be atomic. 3824 * 3825 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this 3826 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the 3827 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG 3828 * should be set as well. 3829 * The callback can sleep. 3830 * 3831 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it) 3832 * The callback can sleep. 3833 * 3834 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station, 3835 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep. 3836 * 3837 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated 3838 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback 3839 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected; 3840 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing 3841 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3842 * This callback can sleep. 3843 * 3844 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3845 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback 3846 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3847 * callback can sleep. 3848 * 3849 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3850 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback 3851 * should be within a CPTCFG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3852 * callback can sleep. 3853 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the 3854 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3855 * 3856 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an 3857 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating 3858 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag 3859 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic. 3860 * 3861 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx 3862 * power for the station. 3863 * This callback can sleep. 3864 * 3865 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a 3866 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.) 3867 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove. 3868 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions 3869 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it 3870 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace 3871 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station. 3872 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3873 * The callback can sleep. 3874 * 3875 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU 3876 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station 3877 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear 3878 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse 3879 * in @sta_state. 3880 * The callback can sleep. 3881 * 3882 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be 3883 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits 3884 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected 3885 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver 3886 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since 3887 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly. 3888 * Must be atomic. 3889 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This 3890 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses 3891 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic. 3892 * 3893 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon 3894 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so 3895 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of 3896 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not 3897 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible. 3898 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211. 3899 * The callback can sleep. 3900 * 3901 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max), 3902 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue. 3903 * Returns a negative error code on failure. 3904 * The callback can sleep. 3905 * 3906 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently, 3907 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a 3908 * required function. 3909 * The callback can sleep. 3910 * 3911 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware. 3912 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a 3913 * required function. 3914 * The callback can sleep. 3915 * 3916 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the 3917 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between 3918 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up 3919 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function. 3920 * The callback can sleep. 3921 * 3922 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize 3923 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This 3924 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of 3925 * TSF synchronization. 3926 * The callback can sleep. 3927 * 3928 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us. 3929 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is 3930 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests. 3931 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon. 3932 * The callback can sleep. 3933 * 3934 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information 3935 * 3936 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also 3937 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration, 3938 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback. 3939 * The callback can sleep. 3940 * 3941 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified 3942 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout 3943 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout 3944 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for 3945 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep. 3946 * 3947 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may 3948 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep. 3949 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep. 3950 * 3951 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure 3952 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap 3953 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces 3954 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues. 3955 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped. 3956 * Note that vif can be NULL. 3957 * The callback can sleep. 3958 * 3959 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel 3960 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this 3961 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate 3962 * completion of the channel switch. 3963 * 3964 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 3965 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 3966 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 3967 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 3968 * 3969 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 3970 * 3971 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must 3972 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note 3973 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw 3974 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted 3975 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the 3976 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call 3977 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(). 3978 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and 3979 * must be accepted in this case. 3980 * This callback may sleep. 3981 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is 3982 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep. 3983 * 3984 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes. 3985 * 3986 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes. 3987 * 3988 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware 3989 * queues before entering power save. 3990 * 3991 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection 3992 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled. 3993 * The callback can sleep. 3994 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See 3995 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types. 3996 * The callback must be atomic. 3997 * 3998 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given 3999 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for 4000 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver 4001 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD. 4002 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check 4003 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than 4004 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in 4005 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the 4006 * more-data bit must always be set. 4007 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames 4008 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set. 4009 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the 4010 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In 4011 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4012 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll 4013 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple 4014 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame. 4015 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be 4016 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send 4017 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for 4018 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the 4019 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP 4020 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function 4021 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP. 4022 * This callback must be atomic. 4023 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames 4024 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211 4025 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames 4026 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set 4027 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case 4028 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder 4029 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4030 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP 4031 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the 4032 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function. 4033 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the 4034 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set. 4035 * This callback must be atomic. 4036 * 4037 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count. 4038 * 4039 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats. 4040 * 4041 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats 4042 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets. 4043 * 4044 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association 4045 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is 4046 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated 4047 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any 4048 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's 4049 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a 4050 * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the 4051 * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response 4052 * and to be able to synchronize with the GO. 4053 * For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211 4054 * would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication 4055 * frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO. 4056 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return 4057 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away. 4058 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info 4059 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the 4060 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested. 4061 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep. 4062 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously 4063 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data 4064 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used. 4065 * 4066 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending 4067 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's 4068 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS 4069 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP. 4070 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS 4071 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least 4072 * 2 * (DTIM period). 4073 * The callback is optional and can sleep. 4074 * 4075 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation. 4076 * This callback may sleep. 4077 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction. 4078 * This callback may sleep. 4079 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that 4080 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same 4081 * channel context with different settings 4082 * This callback may sleep. 4083 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound 4084 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping. 4085 * This callback may sleep. 4086 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being 4087 * unbound from vif. 4088 * This callback may sleep. 4089 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to 4090 * another, as specified in the list of 4091 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according 4092 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode. 4093 * This callback may sleep. 4094 * 4095 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the 4096 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel 4097 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses 4098 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is 4099 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being 4100 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed. 4101 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface. 4102 * 4103 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and 4104 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed. 4105 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and 4106 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames). 4107 * This callback may sleep. 4108 * 4109 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed. 4110 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces. 4111 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep. 4112 * 4113 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel. 4114 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this 4115 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be 4116 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call 4117 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get() 4118 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is 4119 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been 4120 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish(). 4121 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called, 4122 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway. 4123 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4124 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA 4125 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing 4126 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch. 4127 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4128 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the 4129 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4130 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4131 * when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the 4132 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4133 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called 4134 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with 4135 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count. 4136 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all 4137 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A 4138 * channel context is bound before this is called. 4139 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again. 4140 * 4141 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the 4142 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0 4143 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide. 4144 * 4145 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration 4146 * and hardware limits. 4147 * 4148 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 4149 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 4150 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The 4151 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of 4152 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation. 4153 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can 4154 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use. 4155 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 4156 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 4157 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or 4158 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets 4159 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue 4160 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch 4161 * response template is provided, together with the location of the 4162 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within 4163 * the function call. 4164 * 4165 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue. 4166 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a 4167 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues 4168 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action 4169 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet. 4170 * 4171 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one. 4172 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster. 4173 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf 4174 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters 4175 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config. 4176 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since 4177 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the 4178 * changed parameters. 4179 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in 4180 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of 4181 * this call. 4182 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call 4183 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with 4184 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal. 4185 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports 4186 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation 4187 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while 4188 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU. 4189 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 4190 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 4191 * 4192 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep) 4193 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep) 4194 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep. 4195 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer. 4196 * This callback may sleep. 4197 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags 4198 * This callback may sleep. 4199 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using 4200 * 4-address mode 4201 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 4202 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed 4203 * to use rx decapsulation offload 4204 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer. 4205 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters 4206 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement. 4207 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of 4208 * twt structure. 4209 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received 4210 * from the peer. 4211 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for 4212 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit 4213 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 4214 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 4215 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 4216 * radar channel. 4217 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to 4218 * disable background CAC/radar detection. 4219 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to 4220 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading 4221 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while 4222 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer), 4223 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or 4224 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation. 4225 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures 4226 * that were already removed, in case they're needed. 4227 * This callback can sleep. 4228 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to 4229 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep. 4230 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links, 4231 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero. 4232 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them. 4233 */ 4234 struct ieee80211_ops { 4235 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4236 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control, 4237 struct sk_buff *skb); 4238 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4239 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4240 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 4241 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan); 4242 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4243 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled); 4244 #endif 4245 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4246 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4247 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4248 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4249 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p); 4250 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4251 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4252 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed); 4253 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4254 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4255 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4256 u64 changed); 4257 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4258 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4259 u64 changed); 4260 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4261 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4262 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4263 u64 changed); 4264 4265 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4266 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4267 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4268 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4269 4270 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4271 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list); 4272 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4273 unsigned int changed_flags, 4274 unsigned int *total_flags, 4275 u64 multicast); 4276 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4277 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4278 unsigned int filter_flags, 4279 unsigned int changed_flags); 4280 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4281 bool set); 4282 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd, 4283 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4284 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key); 4285 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4286 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4287 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf, 4288 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4289 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key); 4290 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4291 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4292 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4293 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4294 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx); 4295 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4296 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req); 4297 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4298 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4299 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4300 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4301 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req, 4302 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies); 4303 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4304 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4305 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4306 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4307 const u8 *mac_addr); 4308 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4309 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4310 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4311 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats); 4312 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4313 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 4314 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 4315 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4316 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4317 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4318 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4319 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4320 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4321 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 4322 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4323 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4324 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4325 struct dentry *dir); 4326 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4327 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4328 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta, 4329 struct dentry *dir); 4330 #endif 4331 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4332 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4333 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4334 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4335 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4336 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4337 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4338 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state, 4339 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state); 4340 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4341 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4342 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4343 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4344 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4345 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4346 u32 changed); 4347 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4348 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4349 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4350 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4351 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4352 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4353 struct station_info *sinfo); 4354 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4355 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4356 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac, 4357 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params); 4358 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4359 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4360 u64 tsf); 4361 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4362 s64 offset); 4363 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4364 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4365 4366 /** 4367 * @ampdu_action: 4368 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action. 4369 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want 4370 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through 4371 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 4372 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver 4373 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size 4374 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the 4375 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be 4376 * possible with a buf_size of 8: 4377 * 4378 * - ``TX: 1.....7`` 4379 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1) 4380 * - ``TX: 8..1...`` 4381 * 4382 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the 4383 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be: 4384 * 4385 * - ``TX: 1 or`` 4386 * - ``TX: 18 or`` 4387 * - ``TX: 81`` 4388 * 4389 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again. 4390 * 4391 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return 4392 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START 4393 * if the session can start immediately. 4394 * 4395 * The callback can sleep. 4396 */ 4397 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4398 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4399 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params); 4400 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx, 4401 struct survey_info *survey); 4402 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4403 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class); 4404 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4405 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4406 void *data, int len); 4407 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb, 4408 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4409 void *data, int len); 4410 #endif 4411 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4412 u32 queues, bool drop); 4413 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4414 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4415 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4416 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4417 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4418 4419 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4420 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4421 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4422 int duration, 4423 enum ieee80211_roc_type type); 4424 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4425 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4426 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx); 4427 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4428 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max); 4429 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4430 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4431 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4432 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4433 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4434 const struct ieee80211_event *event); 4435 4436 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4437 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4438 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4439 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4440 bool more_data); 4441 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4442 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4443 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4444 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4445 bool more_data); 4446 4447 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4448 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset); 4449 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4450 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4451 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data); 4452 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4453 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4454 u32 sset, u8 *data); 4455 4456 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4457 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4458 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4459 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4460 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4461 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4462 4463 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4464 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4465 4466 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4467 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4468 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4469 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4470 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4471 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx, 4472 u32 changed); 4473 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4474 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4475 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4476 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4477 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4478 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4479 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4480 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4481 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4482 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs, 4483 int n_vifs, 4484 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode); 4485 4486 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4487 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type); 4488 4489 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6) 4490 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4491 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4492 struct inet6_dev *idev); 4493 #endif 4494 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4495 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4496 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4497 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4498 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4499 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4500 4501 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4502 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4503 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4504 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4505 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4506 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4507 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4508 4509 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4510 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4511 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4512 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4513 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4514 int *dbm); 4515 4516 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4517 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4518 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class, 4519 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4520 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie); 4521 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4522 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4523 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4524 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4525 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4526 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params); 4527 4528 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4529 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 4530 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4531 4532 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4533 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4534 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4535 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4536 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4537 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4538 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4539 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes); 4540 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4541 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4542 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4543 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4544 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4545 u8 instance_id); 4546 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4547 struct sk_buff *head, 4548 struct sk_buff *skb); 4549 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4550 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4551 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4552 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4553 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4554 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4555 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4556 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4557 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4558 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4559 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4560 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4561 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4562 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids); 4563 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4564 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4565 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4566 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4567 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4568 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4569 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4570 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4571 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4572 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4573 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4574 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt); 4575 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4576 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid); 4577 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4578 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4579 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4580 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4581 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4582 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx, 4583 struct net_device_path *path); 4584 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4585 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4586 u16 old_links, u16 new_links, 4587 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]); 4588 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4589 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4590 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4591 u16 old_links, u16 new_links); 4592 }; 4593 4594 /** 4595 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device 4596 * 4597 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4598 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4599 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4600 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4601 * @priv_data_len. 4602 * 4603 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4604 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4605 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device. 4606 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d) 4607 * 4608 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4609 */ 4610 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len, 4611 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops, 4612 const char *requested_name); 4613 4614 /** 4615 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device 4616 * 4617 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4618 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4619 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4620 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4621 * @priv_data_len. 4622 * 4623 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4624 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4625 * 4626 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4627 */ 4628 static inline 4629 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len, 4630 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops) 4631 { 4632 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL); 4633 } 4634 4635 /** 4636 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device 4637 * 4638 * You must call this function before any other functions in 4639 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you 4640 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information. 4641 * 4642 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw() 4643 * 4644 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise. 4645 */ 4646 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4647 4648 /** 4649 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description 4650 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec 4651 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds 4652 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period) 4653 */ 4654 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink { 4655 int throughput; 4656 int blink_time; 4657 }; 4658 4659 /** 4660 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags 4661 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio 4662 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working 4663 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one 4664 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP 4665 */ 4666 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags { 4667 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0), 4668 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1), 4669 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2), 4670 }; 4671 4672 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4673 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4674 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4675 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4676 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4677 const char * 4678 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4679 unsigned int flags, 4680 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4681 unsigned int blink_table_len); 4682 #endif 4683 /** 4684 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED 4685 * 4686 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4687 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4688 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4689 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4690 * 4691 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4692 * 4693 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4694 */ 4695 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4696 { 4697 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4698 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw); 4699 #else 4700 return NULL; 4701 #endif 4702 } 4703 4704 /** 4705 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED 4706 * 4707 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4708 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4709 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4710 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4711 * 4712 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4713 * 4714 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4715 */ 4716 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4717 { 4718 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4719 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw); 4720 #else 4721 return NULL; 4722 #endif 4723 } 4724 4725 /** 4726 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED 4727 * 4728 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4729 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4730 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4731 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4732 * 4733 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4734 * 4735 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4736 */ 4737 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4738 { 4739 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4740 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw); 4741 #else 4742 return NULL; 4743 #endif 4744 } 4745 4746 /** 4747 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED 4748 * 4749 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4750 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4751 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4752 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4753 * 4754 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4755 * 4756 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4757 */ 4758 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4759 { 4760 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4761 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw); 4762 #else 4763 return NULL; 4764 #endif 4765 } 4766 4767 /** 4768 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger 4769 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for 4770 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags 4771 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput 4772 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table 4773 * 4774 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are 4775 * configured) or the name of the new trigger. 4776 * 4777 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw(). 4778 */ 4779 static inline const char * 4780 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags, 4781 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4782 unsigned int blink_table_len) 4783 { 4784 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4785 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table, 4786 blink_table_len); 4787 #else 4788 return NULL; 4789 #endif 4790 } 4791 4792 /** 4793 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device 4794 * 4795 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources 4796 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem. 4797 * 4798 * @hw: the hardware to unregister 4799 */ 4800 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4801 4802 /** 4803 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor 4804 * 4805 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the 4806 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw() 4807 * before calling this function. 4808 * 4809 * @hw: the hardware to free 4810 */ 4811 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4812 4813 /** 4814 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely 4815 * 4816 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason 4817 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state 4818 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware 4819 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by 4820 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all 4821 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function. 4822 * 4823 * @hw: the hardware to restart 4824 */ 4825 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4826 4827 /** 4828 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list 4829 * 4830 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4831 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4832 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4833 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4834 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4835 * 4836 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4837 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4838 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4839 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4840 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4841 * 4842 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock 4843 * 4844 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4845 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4846 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4847 * @list: the destination list 4848 */ 4849 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4850 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list); 4851 4852 /** 4853 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context 4854 * 4855 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4856 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4857 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4858 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4859 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4860 * 4861 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4862 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4863 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4864 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4865 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4866 * 4867 * This function must be called with BHs disabled. 4868 * 4869 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4870 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4871 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4872 * @napi: the NAPI context 4873 */ 4874 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4875 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi); 4876 4877 /** 4878 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame 4879 * 4880 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4881 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4882 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4883 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4884 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4885 * 4886 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4887 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4888 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4889 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4890 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4891 * 4892 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni(). 4893 * 4894 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4895 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4896 */ 4897 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb) 4898 { 4899 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL); 4900 } 4901 4902 /** 4903 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame 4904 * 4905 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context 4906 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 4907 * 4908 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not 4909 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with 4910 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4911 * 4912 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4913 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4914 */ 4915 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 4916 4917 /** 4918 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context) 4919 * 4920 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context 4921 * (internally disables bottom halves). 4922 * 4923 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may 4924 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4925 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4926 * 4927 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4928 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4929 */ 4930 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4931 struct sk_buff *skb) 4932 { 4933 local_bh_disable(); 4934 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb); 4935 local_bh_enable(); 4936 } 4937 4938 /** 4939 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta 4940 * 4941 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS 4942 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station 4943 * entering/leaving PS mode. 4944 * 4945 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled. 4946 * 4947 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against 4948 * each other. 4949 * 4950 * @sta: currently connected sta 4951 * @start: start or stop PS 4952 * 4953 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set. 4954 */ 4955 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start); 4956 4957 /** 4958 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta 4959 * (in process context) 4960 * 4961 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context 4962 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still 4963 * applies. 4964 * 4965 * @sta: currently connected sta 4966 * @start: start or stop PS 4967 * 4968 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(). 4969 */ 4970 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4971 bool start) 4972 { 4973 int ret; 4974 4975 local_bh_disable(); 4976 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start); 4977 local_bh_enable(); 4978 4979 return ret; 4980 } 4981 4982 /** 4983 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received 4984 * @sta: currently connected station 4985 * 4986 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 4987 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a 4988 * connected station was received. 4989 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 4990 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must 4991 * be serialized. 4992 */ 4993 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4994 4995 /** 4996 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received 4997 * @sta: currently connected station 4998 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame 4999 * 5000 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5001 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame 5002 * from a connected station was received. 5003 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5004 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be 5005 * serialized. 5006 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown. 5007 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC 5008 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper 5009 * checks. 5010 */ 5011 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 5012 5013 /* 5014 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions. 5015 * This is enough for the radiotap header. 5016 */ 5017 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4) 5018 5019 /** 5020 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames 5021 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station 5022 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames 5023 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID 5024 * 5025 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing 5026 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need 5027 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit. 5028 * 5029 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are 5030 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data 5031 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim 5032 * call! Beware of the locking!) 5033 * 5034 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD) 5035 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are 5036 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes 5037 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data, 5038 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered 5039 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP). 5040 * 5041 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per 5042 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since 5043 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the 5044 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that 5045 * use this API. 5046 */ 5047 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5048 u8 tid, bool buffered); 5049 5050 /** 5051 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet 5052 * 5053 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support 5054 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent 5055 * rate selection table for the station entry. 5056 * 5057 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5058 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent. 5059 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 5060 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information 5061 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch 5062 */ 5063 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5064 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5065 struct sk_buff *skb, 5066 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest, 5067 int max_rates); 5068 5069 /** 5070 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station 5071 * 5072 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput 5073 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can 5074 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station 5075 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic 5076 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause 5077 * slow stations to starve). 5078 * 5079 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for. 5080 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps. 5081 */ 5082 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5083 u32 thr); 5084 5085 /** 5086 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback 5087 * 5088 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta 5089 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision 5090 * in updating the tx rate in data path. 5091 * 5092 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5093 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for. 5094 * @info: tx status information 5095 */ 5096 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5097 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5098 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info); 5099 5100 /** 5101 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback 5102 * 5103 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been 5104 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for 5105 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics. 5106 * 5107 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 5108 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls 5109 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() 5110 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 5111 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni(). 5112 * 5113 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5114 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5115 */ 5116 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5117 struct sk_buff *skb); 5118 5119 /** 5120 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback 5121 * 5122 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status 5123 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not 5124 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info. 5125 * 5126 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5127 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5128 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5129 * 5130 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5131 * @status: tx status information 5132 */ 5133 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5134 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status); 5135 5136 /** 5137 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb 5138 * 5139 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status 5140 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to 5141 * specific skbs. 5142 * 5143 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5144 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5145 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5146 * 5147 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5148 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent 5149 * (NULL for multicast packets) 5150 * @info: tx status information 5151 */ 5152 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5153 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5154 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 5155 { 5156 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = { 5157 .sta = sta, 5158 .info = info, 5159 }; 5160 5161 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status); 5162 } 5163 5164 /** 5165 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context) 5166 * 5167 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context. 5168 * 5169 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and 5170 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed 5171 * for a single hardware. 5172 * 5173 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5174 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5175 */ 5176 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5177 struct sk_buff *skb) 5178 { 5179 local_bh_disable(); 5180 ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb); 5181 local_bh_enable(); 5182 } 5183 5184 /** 5185 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback 5186 * 5187 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context 5188 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 5189 * 5190 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and 5191 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5192 * 5193 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5194 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5195 */ 5196 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5197 struct sk_buff *skb); 5198 5199 /** 5200 * ieee80211_tx_status_8023 - transmit status callback for 802.3 frame format 5201 * 5202 * Call this function for all transmitted data frames after their transmit 5203 * completion. This callback should only be called for data frames which 5204 * are using driver's (or hardware's) offload capability of encap/decap 5205 * 802.11 frames. 5206 * 5207 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 5208 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other and all 5209 * calls in the same tx status family. 5210 * 5211 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5212 * @vif: the interface for which the frame was transmitted 5213 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5214 */ 5215 void ieee80211_tx_status_8023(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5216 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5217 struct sk_buff *skb); 5218 5219 /** 5220 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station 5221 * 5222 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding 5223 * connected STA. 5224 * 5225 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta 5226 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response 5227 */ 5228 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets); 5229 5230 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2 5231 5232 /** 5233 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets 5234 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element 5235 * @tim_length: size of TIM element 5236 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets 5237 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which 5238 * should be ignored. 5239 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element 5240 */ 5241 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets { 5242 u16 tim_offset; 5243 u16 tim_length; 5244 5245 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM]; 5246 u16 mbssid_off; 5247 }; 5248 5249 /** 5250 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function 5251 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5252 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5253 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5254 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5255 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP) 5256 * 5257 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5258 * obtain the beacon template. 5259 * 5260 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the 5261 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template 5262 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when 5263 * applicable, the CSA count. 5264 * 5265 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5266 * 5267 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5268 */ 5269 struct sk_buff * 5270 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5271 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5272 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5273 unsigned int link_id); 5274 5275 /** 5276 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function 5277 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5278 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5279 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset. 5280 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5281 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length, 5282 * (including the ID and length bytes!). 5283 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5284 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP) 5285 * 5286 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5287 * obtain the beacon frame. 5288 * 5289 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5290 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon 5291 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly 5292 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt). 5293 * 5294 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5295 * 5296 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5297 */ 5298 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5299 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5300 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length, 5301 unsigned int link_id); 5302 5303 /** 5304 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function 5305 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5306 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5307 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP) 5308 * 5309 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5310 * 5311 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5312 */ 5313 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5314 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5315 unsigned int link_id) 5316 { 5317 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id); 5318 } 5319 5320 /** 5321 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown 5322 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5323 * 5324 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission. 5325 * This function is called implicitly when 5326 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the 5327 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this 5328 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown. 5329 * 5330 * Return: new countdown value 5331 */ 5332 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5333 5334 /** 5335 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown 5336 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5337 * @counter: the new value for the counter 5338 * 5339 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be 5340 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211. 5341 * 5342 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(), 5343 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value. 5344 */ 5345 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter); 5346 5347 /** 5348 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch 5349 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5350 * 5351 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5352 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5353 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed. 5354 */ 5355 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5356 5357 /** 5358 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1 5359 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5360 * 5361 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero. 5362 */ 5363 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5364 5365 /** 5366 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change 5367 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5368 * 5369 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5370 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5371 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed 5372 */ 5373 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5374 5375 /** 5376 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template 5377 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5378 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5379 * 5380 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5381 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller. 5382 * 5383 * Can only be called in AP mode. 5384 * 5385 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error. 5386 */ 5387 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5388 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5389 5390 /** 5391 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template 5392 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5393 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5394 * 5395 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to 5396 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5397 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used. 5398 * 5399 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5400 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit. 5401 * 5402 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error. 5403 */ 5404 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5405 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5406 5407 /** 5408 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template 5409 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5410 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5411 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses 5412 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with 5413 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be. 5414 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set 5415 * if at all possible 5416 * 5417 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to 5418 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5419 * BSSID and address is used. 5420 * 5421 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the 5422 * returned packet will be QoS NDP. 5423 * 5424 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5425 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields. 5426 * 5427 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error. 5428 */ 5429 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5430 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5431 int link_id, bool qos_ok); 5432 5433 /** 5434 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 5435 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5436 * @src_addr: source MAC address 5437 * @ssid: SSID buffer 5438 * @ssid_len: length of SSID 5439 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs 5440 * 5441 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5442 * hardware. 5443 * 5444 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 5445 */ 5446 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5447 const u8 *src_addr, 5448 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 5449 size_t tailroom); 5450 5451 /** 5452 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function 5453 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5454 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5455 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5456 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5457 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5458 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame. 5459 * 5460 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5461 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5462 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5463 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed. 5464 */ 5465 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5466 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5467 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5468 struct ieee80211_rts *rts); 5469 5470 /** 5471 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame 5472 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5473 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5474 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5475 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5476 * 5477 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5478 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5479 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5480 * 5481 * Return: The duration. 5482 */ 5483 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5484 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len, 5485 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5486 5487 /** 5488 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function 5489 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5490 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5491 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5492 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5493 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5494 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame. 5495 * 5496 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5497 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5498 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5499 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed. 5500 */ 5501 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5502 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5503 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5504 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5505 struct ieee80211_cts *cts); 5506 5507 /** 5508 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame 5509 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5510 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5511 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5512 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5513 * 5514 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5515 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5516 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5517 * 5518 * Return: The duration. 5519 */ 5520 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5521 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5522 size_t frame_len, 5523 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5524 5525 /** 5526 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame 5527 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5528 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5529 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on 5530 * @frame_len: the length of the frame. 5531 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted. 5532 * 5533 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its 5534 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps). 5535 * 5536 * Return: The duration. 5537 */ 5538 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5539 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5540 enum nl80211_band band, 5541 size_t frame_len, 5542 struct ieee80211_rate *rate); 5543 5544 /** 5545 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames 5546 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5547 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5548 * 5549 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If 5550 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast 5551 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host 5552 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered 5553 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame. 5554 * 5555 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered 5556 * frames are available. 5557 * 5558 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was 5559 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus 5560 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns 5561 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver 5562 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to 5563 * use common code for all beacons. 5564 */ 5565 struct sk_buff * 5566 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5567 5568 /** 5569 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32 5570 * 5571 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32. 5572 * 5573 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5574 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5575 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5576 */ 5577 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5578 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5579 5580 /** 5581 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key 5582 * 5583 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken 5584 * from the given packet. 5585 * 5586 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5587 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted 5588 * with this P1K 5589 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5590 */ 5591 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5592 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k) 5593 { 5594 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data; 5595 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control); 5596 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]); 5597 5598 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k); 5599 } 5600 5601 /** 5602 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX 5603 * 5604 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32 5605 * and transmitter address. 5606 * 5607 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5608 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key 5609 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5610 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5611 */ 5612 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5613 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5614 5615 /** 5616 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key 5617 * 5618 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values 5619 * in the packet. 5620 * 5621 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5622 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be 5623 * encrypted with this key 5624 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes 5625 */ 5626 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5627 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k); 5628 5629 /** 5630 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos 5631 * 5632 * @pos: start of crypto header 5633 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5634 * @pn: PN to add 5635 * 5636 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of 5637 * the packet payload) 5638 * 5639 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should 5640 * point to the crypto header) 5641 */ 5642 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn); 5643 5644 /** 5645 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter 5646 * 5647 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5648 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5649 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5650 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5651 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data 5652 * 5653 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs 5654 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done 5655 * by the device and not by mac80211. 5656 * 5657 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5658 * can be done concurrently. 5659 */ 5660 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5661 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5662 5663 /** 5664 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter 5665 * 5666 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5667 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5668 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5669 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5670 * @seq: new sequence data 5671 * 5672 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the 5673 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK 5674 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called 5675 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211. 5676 * 5677 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5678 * can be done concurrently. 5679 */ 5680 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5681 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5682 5683 /** 5684 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key 5685 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5686 * 5687 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the 5688 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but 5689 * instead assumed to have been removed already. 5690 * 5691 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently) 5692 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().) 5693 */ 5694 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5695 5696 /** 5697 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN 5698 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on 5699 * @keyconf: new key data 5700 * 5701 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new 5702 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper 5703 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them. 5704 * 5705 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will 5706 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to 5707 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an 5708 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc. 5709 * 5710 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware 5711 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK 5712 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver 5713 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses 5714 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part 5715 * of the reconfiguration. 5716 * 5717 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq() 5718 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly. 5719 * 5720 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware, 5721 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases 5722 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for 5723 * the key that's being replaced. 5724 */ 5725 struct ieee80211_key_conf * 5726 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5727 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5728 5729 /** 5730 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying 5731 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on 5732 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association 5733 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying 5734 * @gfp: allocation flags 5735 */ 5736 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid, 5737 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 5738 5739 /** 5740 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key 5741 * 5742 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5743 * at the same time. 5744 * 5745 * @keyconf: the key in question 5746 */ 5747 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5748 5749 /** 5750 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key 5751 * 5752 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5753 * at the same time. 5754 * 5755 * @keyconf: the key in question 5756 */ 5757 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5758 5759 /** 5760 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue 5761 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5762 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5763 * 5764 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue. 5765 */ 5766 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5767 5768 /** 5769 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue 5770 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5771 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5772 * 5773 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue. 5774 */ 5775 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5776 5777 /** 5778 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue 5779 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5780 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5781 * 5782 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped. 5783 * 5784 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise. 5785 */ 5786 5787 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5788 5789 /** 5790 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues 5791 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5792 * 5793 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues. 5794 */ 5795 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5796 5797 /** 5798 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues 5799 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5800 * 5801 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues. 5802 */ 5803 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5804 5805 /** 5806 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan 5807 * 5808 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is 5809 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify 5810 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from 5811 * any context, including hardirq context. 5812 * 5813 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan 5814 * @info: information about the completed scan 5815 */ 5816 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5817 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 5818 5819 /** 5820 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan 5821 * 5822 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the 5823 * driver whenever there are new scan results available. 5824 * 5825 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 5826 */ 5827 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5828 5829 /** 5830 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped 5831 * 5832 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by 5833 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task. 5834 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan 5835 * while associating, for instance. 5836 * 5837 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 5838 */ 5839 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5840 5841 /** 5842 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags 5843 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have 5844 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware 5845 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new 5846 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they 5847 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 5848 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all 5849 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 5850 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up). 5851 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA 5852 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery 5853 * for instance. 5854 */ 5855 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags { 5856 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0, 5857 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0), 5858 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1), 5859 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2), 5860 }; 5861 5862 /** 5863 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces 5864 * 5865 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5866 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as 5867 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep. 5868 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 5869 * 5870 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5871 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5872 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 5873 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5874 */ 5875 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 5876 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 5877 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 5878 void *data); 5879 5880 /** 5881 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces 5882 * 5883 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5884 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 5885 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator 5886 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can 5887 * be used. 5888 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 5889 * 5890 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5891 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5892 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 5893 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5894 */ 5895 static inline void 5896 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 5897 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 5898 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 5899 void *data) 5900 { 5901 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, 5902 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE, 5903 iterator, data); 5904 } 5905 5906 /** 5907 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces 5908 * 5909 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5910 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 5911 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 5912 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead. 5913 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 5914 * 5915 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5916 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5917 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 5918 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5919 */ 5920 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5921 u32 iter_flags, 5922 void (*iterator)(void *data, 5923 u8 *mac, 5924 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 5925 void *data); 5926 5927 /** 5928 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces 5929 * 5930 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5931 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 5932 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex. 5933 * 5934 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5935 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5936 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 5937 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5938 */ 5939 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5940 u32 iter_flags, 5941 void (*iterator)(void *data, 5942 u8 *mac, 5943 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 5944 void *data); 5945 5946 /** 5947 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations 5948 * 5949 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given 5950 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback 5951 * function for them. 5952 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 5953 * 5954 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5955 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 5956 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5957 */ 5958 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5959 void (*iterator)(void *data, 5960 struct ieee80211_sta *sta), 5961 void *data); 5962 /** 5963 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 5964 * 5965 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue. 5966 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be. 5967 * 5968 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 5969 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue 5970 */ 5971 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work); 5972 5973 /** 5974 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 5975 * 5976 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211 5977 * workqueue. 5978 * 5979 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 5980 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue 5981 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing 5982 */ 5983 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5984 struct delayed_work *dwork, 5985 unsigned long delay); 5986 5987 /** 5988 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session. 5989 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 5990 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 5991 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs) 5992 * 5993 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise 5994 * 5995 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 5996 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 5997 * will be managed by the mac80211. 5998 */ 5999 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid, 6000 u16 timeout); 6001 6002 /** 6003 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate. 6004 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6005 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6006 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6007 * 6008 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6009 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called 6010 * from any context. 6011 */ 6012 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6013 u16 tid); 6014 6015 /** 6016 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session. 6017 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop 6018 * @tid: the TID to stop BA. 6019 * 6020 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active 6021 * 6022 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6023 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6024 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6025 */ 6026 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid); 6027 6028 /** 6029 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate. 6030 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6031 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6032 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on. 6033 * 6034 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6035 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It 6036 * can be called from any context. 6037 */ 6038 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6039 u16 tid); 6040 6041 /** 6042 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station 6043 * 6044 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on 6045 * @addr: station's address 6046 * 6047 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6048 * 6049 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6050 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6051 */ 6052 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6053 const u8 *addr); 6054 6055 /** 6056 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware 6057 * 6058 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6059 * @addr: remote station's address 6060 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'. 6061 * 6062 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6063 * 6064 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6065 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6066 * 6067 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get 6068 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'. 6069 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple 6070 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another 6071 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first). 6072 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL 6073 * is not reliable. 6074 * 6075 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible. 6076 */ 6077 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6078 const u8 *addr, 6079 const u8 *localaddr); 6080 6081 /** 6082 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses 6083 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6084 * @addr: remote station's link address 6085 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that) 6086 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found, 6087 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed 6088 * 6089 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection. 6090 */ 6091 struct ieee80211_sta * 6092 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6093 const u8 *addr, 6094 const u8 *localaddr, 6095 unsigned int *link_id); 6096 6097 /** 6098 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up 6099 * @hw: the hardware 6100 * @pubsta: the station 6101 * @block: whether to block or unblock 6102 * 6103 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues 6104 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before 6105 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be 6106 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected 6107 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag. 6108 * 6109 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free 6110 * manner. 6111 * 6112 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames 6113 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not 6114 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call 6115 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to 6116 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the 6117 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must 6118 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will 6119 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if 6120 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also 6121 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver 6122 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after 6123 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually 6124 * woke up while blocked or not. 6125 */ 6126 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6127 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block); 6128 6129 /** 6130 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP 6131 * @pubsta: the station 6132 * 6133 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell 6134 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the 6135 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead. 6136 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD. 6137 * 6138 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must 6139 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function 6140 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or 6141 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix! 6142 * 6143 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no 6144 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if 6145 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history 6146 * and restore the _irqsafe version! 6147 */ 6148 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6149 6150 /** 6151 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP 6152 * @pubsta: the station 6153 * @tid: the tid of the NDP 6154 * 6155 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close 6156 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when 6157 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window. 6158 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a 6159 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the 6160 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to 6161 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any 6162 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong. 6163 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame 6164 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save. 6165 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames(). 6166 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver 6167 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call 6168 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent. 6169 */ 6170 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid); 6171 6172 /** 6173 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change 6174 * @pubsta: the station 6175 * 6176 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in 6177 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of 6178 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta. 6179 * 6180 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case 6181 * there is no need to call this function. 6182 */ 6183 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6184 6185 /** 6186 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid 6187 * 6188 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call 6189 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of 6190 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule 6191 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness. 6192 * 6193 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent 6194 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not 6195 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the 6196 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame 6197 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission 6198 * attempts. 6199 * 6200 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or 6201 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available. 6202 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of 6203 * them to 0. 6204 * 6205 * @pubsta: the station 6206 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for 6207 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec) 6208 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec) 6209 */ 6210 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6211 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime); 6212 6213 /** 6214 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device 6215 * 6216 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6217 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 6218 * 6219 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can 6220 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false. 6221 */ 6222 bool 6223 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 6224 6225 /** 6226 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device 6227 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6228 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6229 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6230 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6231 * 6232 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6233 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6234 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device 6235 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due 6236 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few 6237 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep. 6238 * 6239 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order 6240 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the 6241 * set_key callback. 6242 */ 6243 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6244 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6245 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6246 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6247 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6248 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6249 void *data), 6250 void *iter_data); 6251 6252 /** 6253 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device 6254 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6255 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6256 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6257 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6258 * 6259 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6260 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6261 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station 6262 * in removal process will be skipped. 6263 * 6264 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section, 6265 * and thus iter must be atomic. 6266 */ 6267 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6268 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6269 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6270 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6271 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6272 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6273 void *data), 6274 void *iter_data); 6275 6276 /** 6277 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts 6278 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6279 * @iter: iterator function 6280 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function 6281 * 6282 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and 6283 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other 6284 * places while calling into the driver. 6285 * 6286 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during 6287 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being 6288 * removed. 6289 * 6290 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed 6291 * before the restart are considered already present so will be 6292 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already 6293 * or not. 6294 */ 6295 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic( 6296 struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6297 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6298 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf, 6299 void *data), 6300 void *iter_data); 6301 6302 /** 6303 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 6304 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6305 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6306 * 6307 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 6308 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate 6309 * information. This function must only be called from within the 6310 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function 6311 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return 6312 * %NULL. 6313 * 6314 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 6315 */ 6316 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6317 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6318 6319 /** 6320 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons 6321 * 6322 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6323 * 6324 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and 6325 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the 6326 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function. 6327 */ 6328 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6329 6330 /** 6331 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP 6332 * 6333 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6334 * 6335 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and 6336 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver 6337 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost. 6338 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated 6339 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set. 6340 * 6341 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state, 6342 * without connection recovery attempts. 6343 */ 6344 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6345 6346 /** 6347 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection 6348 * 6349 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6350 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired 6351 * 6352 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a 6353 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired. 6354 */ 6355 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect); 6356 6357 /** 6358 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume 6359 * 6360 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6361 * 6362 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume. 6363 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the 6364 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were 6365 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or 6366 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume. 6367 * 6368 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses 6369 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface 6370 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then 6371 * disconnect normally later. 6372 * 6373 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and 6374 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it 6375 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the 6376 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto). 6377 */ 6378 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6379 6380 /** 6381 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after 6382 * hardware restart 6383 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6384 * 6385 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after 6386 * hardware restart. 6387 */ 6388 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6389 6390 /** 6391 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring 6392 * rssi threshold triggered 6393 * 6394 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6395 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type 6396 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 6397 * @gfp: context flags 6398 * 6399 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality 6400 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform 6401 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold. 6402 */ 6403 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6404 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 6405 s32 rssi_level, 6406 gfp_t gfp); 6407 6408 /** 6409 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss 6410 * 6411 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6412 * @gfp: context flags 6413 */ 6414 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp); 6415 6416 /** 6417 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected 6418 * 6419 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6420 */ 6421 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6422 6423 /** 6424 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process 6425 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6426 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not 6427 * 6428 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel 6429 * and wake up the suspended queues. 6430 */ 6431 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success); 6432 6433 /** 6434 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error 6435 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6436 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame. 6437 * 6438 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel 6439 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send 6440 * a deauth frame in this case. 6441 */ 6442 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6443 bool block_tx); 6444 6445 /** 6446 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition 6447 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6448 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0 6449 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode 6450 * 6451 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed 6452 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than 6453 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth. 6454 */ 6455 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6456 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode); 6457 6458 /** 6459 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start 6460 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6461 */ 6462 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6463 6464 /** 6465 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 6466 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6467 */ 6468 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6469 6470 /** 6471 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions 6472 * 6473 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device 6474 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba 6475 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs 6476 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)." 6477 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and 6478 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation. 6479 * 6480 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6481 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid 6482 * @addr: & to bssid mac address 6483 */ 6484 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap, 6485 const u8 *addr); 6486 6487 /** 6488 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered 6489 * @pubsta: station struct 6490 * @tid: the session's TID 6491 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are 6492 * assumed to be out of the window after the call 6493 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc. 6494 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware 6495 * 6496 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and 6497 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it 6498 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released 6499 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.) 6500 */ 6501 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6502 u16 ssn, u64 filtered, 6503 u16 received_mpdus); 6504 6505 /** 6506 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame 6507 * 6508 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder 6509 * buffer. 6510 * 6511 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6512 * @ra: the peer's destination address 6513 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session 6514 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver 6515 */ 6516 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn); 6517 6518 /** 6519 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work 6520 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6521 * @addr: station mac address 6522 * @tid: the rx tid 6523 */ 6524 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr, 6525 unsigned int tid); 6526 6527 /** 6528 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session 6529 * 6530 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6531 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6532 * reordering. 6533 * 6534 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6535 * when they complete AddBa negotiation. 6536 * 6537 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6538 * @addr: station mac address 6539 * @tid: the rx tid 6540 */ 6541 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6542 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6543 { 6544 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6545 return; 6546 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid); 6547 } 6548 6549 /** 6550 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session 6551 * 6552 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6553 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6554 * reordering. 6555 * 6556 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6557 * when they complete DelBa negotiation. 6558 * 6559 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6560 * @addr: station mac address 6561 * @tid: the rx tid 6562 */ 6563 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6564 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6565 { 6566 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6567 return; 6568 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS); 6569 } 6570 6571 /** 6572 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout 6573 * 6574 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx 6575 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer. 6576 * 6577 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa. 6578 * 6579 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6580 * @addr: station mac address 6581 * @tid: the rx tid 6582 */ 6583 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6584 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid); 6585 6586 /* Rate control API */ 6587 6588 /** 6589 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo 6590 * 6591 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for. 6592 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on. 6593 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration 6594 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs 6595 * to be filled in 6596 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate 6597 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and 6598 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network. 6599 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the 6600 * RTS threshold 6601 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission 6602 * if the selected rate supports it 6603 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask 6604 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use) 6605 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode 6606 */ 6607 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control { 6608 struct ieee80211_hw *hw; 6609 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband; 6610 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf; 6611 struct sk_buff *skb; 6612 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate; 6613 bool rts, short_preamble; 6614 u32 rate_idx_mask; 6615 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask; 6616 bool bss; 6617 }; 6618 6619 /** 6620 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities 6621 */ 6622 enum rate_control_capabilities { 6623 /** 6624 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: 6625 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable) 6626 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains 6627 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has, 6628 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us. 6629 */ 6630 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0), 6631 /** 6632 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER: 6633 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx 6634 */ 6635 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1), 6636 }; 6637 6638 struct rate_control_ops { 6639 unsigned long capa; 6640 const char *name; 6641 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6642 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv, 6643 struct dentry *debugfsdir); 6644 void (*free)(void *priv); 6645 6646 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp); 6647 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6648 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6649 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta); 6650 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6651 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6652 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6653 u32 changed); 6654 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6655 void *priv_sta); 6656 6657 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv, 6658 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6659 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st); 6660 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6661 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6662 struct sk_buff *skb); 6663 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6664 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc); 6665 6666 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta, 6667 struct dentry *dir); 6668 6669 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta); 6670 }; 6671 6672 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6673 enum nl80211_band band, 6674 int index) 6675 { 6676 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index)); 6677 } 6678 6679 static inline s8 6680 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6681 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6682 { 6683 int i; 6684 6685 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6686 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6687 return i; 6688 6689 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */ 6690 WARN_ON_ONCE(1); 6691 6692 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */ 6693 return 0; 6694 } 6695 6696 static inline 6697 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6698 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6699 { 6700 unsigned int i; 6701 6702 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6703 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6704 return true; 6705 return false; 6706 } 6707 6708 /** 6709 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver 6710 * 6711 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass 6712 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station 6713 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on 6714 * the most recent rate control module decision. 6715 * 6716 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6717 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. 6718 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station. 6719 */ 6720 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6721 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 6722 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates); 6723 6724 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6725 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6726 6727 static inline bool 6728 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6729 { 6730 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6731 } 6732 6733 static inline bool 6734 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6735 { 6736 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6737 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6738 } 6739 6740 static inline bool 6741 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6742 { 6743 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6744 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6745 } 6746 6747 static inline bool 6748 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6749 { 6750 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40; 6751 } 6752 6753 static inline bool 6754 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6755 { 6756 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) && 6757 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) && 6758 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT); 6759 } 6760 6761 static inline enum nl80211_iftype 6762 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p) 6763 { 6764 if (p2p) { 6765 switch (type) { 6766 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: 6767 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT; 6768 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: 6769 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO; 6770 default: 6771 break; 6772 } 6773 } 6774 return type; 6775 } 6776 6777 static inline enum nl80211_iftype 6778 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6779 { 6780 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p); 6781 } 6782 6783 /** 6784 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data 6785 * 6786 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 6787 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0 6788 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 6789 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 6790 * 6791 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and 6792 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the 6793 * matching GroupId management frame. 6794 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path. 6795 */ 6796 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6797 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position); 6798 6799 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6800 int rssi_min_thold, 6801 int rssi_max_thold); 6802 6803 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6804 6805 /** 6806 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface 6807 * 6808 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 6809 * 6810 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid. 6811 * 6812 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not 6813 * applicable. 6814 */ 6815 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6816 6817 /** 6818 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup 6819 * @vif: virtual interface 6820 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s) 6821 * @gfp: allocation flags 6822 * 6823 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(). 6824 */ 6825 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6826 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 6827 gfp_t gfp); 6828 6829 /** 6830 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission 6831 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6832 * @vif: virtual interface 6833 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver 6834 * @band: the band to transmit on 6835 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to 6836 * 6837 * Note: must be called under RCU lock 6838 */ 6839 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6840 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb, 6841 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta); 6842 6843 /** 6844 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header 6845 * of injected frames. 6846 * 6847 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields, 6848 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure 6849 * of the skb before calling this function. 6850 * 6851 * @skb: packet injected by userspace 6852 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 6853 */ 6854 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb, 6855 struct net_device *dev); 6856 6857 /** 6858 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state 6859 * 6860 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change 6861 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending 6862 * 6863 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent 6864 * 6865 * private: 6866 * 6867 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors 6868 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA 6869 */ 6870 struct ieee80211_noa_data { 6871 u32 next_tsf; 6872 bool has_next_tsf; 6873 6874 u8 absent; 6875 6876 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 6877 struct { 6878 u32 start; 6879 u32 duration; 6880 u32 interval; 6881 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 6882 }; 6883 6884 /** 6885 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE 6886 * 6887 * @attr: P2P NoA IE 6888 * @data: NoA tracking data 6889 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 6890 * 6891 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors 6892 */ 6893 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr, 6894 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 6895 6896 /** 6897 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change 6898 * 6899 * @data: NoA tracking data 6900 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 6901 */ 6902 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 6903 6904 /** 6905 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation 6906 * @vif: virtual interface 6907 * @peer: the peer's destination address 6908 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation 6909 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown 6910 * @gfp: allocation flags 6911 * 6912 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(). 6913 */ 6914 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer, 6915 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 6916 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 6917 6918 /** 6919 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID 6920 * 6921 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from 6922 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such 6923 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID, 6924 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks 6925 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be 6926 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC. 6927 * 6928 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it 6929 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should 6930 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback. 6931 * 6932 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for 6933 * @tid: the TID to reserve 6934 * 6935 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure 6936 */ 6937 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 6938 6939 /** 6940 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID 6941 * 6942 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function 6943 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for 6944 * preventing use of this TID in the driver. 6945 * 6946 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called 6947 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called 6948 * from the driver's @sta_state callback. 6949 * 6950 * @sta: the station 6951 * @tid: the TID to unreserve 6952 */ 6953 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 6954 6955 /** 6956 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 6957 * 6958 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6959 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 6960 * ieee80211_next_txq() 6961 * 6962 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available. 6963 * 6964 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section, 6965 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in 6966 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the 6967 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call 6968 * but for the duration of the frame handling. 6969 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method, 6970 * rcu_read_lock() is already held. 6971 * 6972 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called. 6973 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead. 6974 */ 6975 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6976 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 6977 6978 /** 6979 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 6980 * (in process context) 6981 * 6982 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context 6983 * (internally disables bottom halves). 6984 * 6985 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6986 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 6987 * ieee80211_next_txq() 6988 */ 6989 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6990 struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 6991 { 6992 struct sk_buff *skb; 6993 6994 local_bh_disable(); 6995 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq); 6996 local_bh_enable(); 6997 6998 return skb; 6999 } 7000 7001 /** 7002 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback 7003 * 7004 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7005 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7006 * 7007 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue 7008 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function. 7009 */ 7010 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7011 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7012 7013 /** 7014 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from 7015 * 7016 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7017 * @ac: AC number to return packets from. 7018 * 7019 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq 7020 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the 7021 * driver has finished scheduling it. 7022 */ 7023 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7024 7025 /** 7026 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs 7027 * 7028 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7029 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for 7030 * 7031 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq(). 7032 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently. 7033 */ 7034 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7035 7036 /* (deprecated) */ 7037 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac) 7038 { 7039 } 7040 7041 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7042 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force); 7043 7044 /** 7045 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission 7046 * 7047 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7048 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7049 * 7050 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled, 7051 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered. 7052 * 7053 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for 7054 * this TXQ internally. 7055 */ 7056 static inline void 7057 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7058 { 7059 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true); 7060 } 7061 7062 /** 7063 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq() 7064 * 7065 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7066 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7067 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets. 7068 * 7069 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ 7070 * internally. 7071 */ 7072 static inline void 7073 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7074 bool force) 7075 { 7076 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force); 7077 } 7078 7079 /** 7080 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit 7081 * 7082 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by 7083 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime 7084 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by 7085 * next_txq(). 7086 * 7087 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to 7088 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have 7089 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will 7090 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit 7091 * again. 7092 * 7093 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be 7094 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates 7095 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry 7096 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this 7097 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets 7098 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq(). 7099 * 7100 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7101 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7102 */ 7103 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7104 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7105 7106 /** 7107 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq 7108 * 7109 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e. 7110 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up 7111 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa. 7112 * 7113 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7114 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count 7115 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count 7116 */ 7117 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7118 unsigned long *frame_cnt, 7119 unsigned long *byte_cnt); 7120 7121 /** 7122 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 7123 * 7124 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination. 7125 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7126 * 7127 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7128 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7129 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 7130 * @gfp: allocation flags 7131 */ 7132 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7133 u8 inst_id, 7134 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 7135 gfp_t gfp); 7136 7137 /** 7138 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event. 7139 * 7140 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The 7141 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211. 7142 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7143 * 7144 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7145 * @match: match event information 7146 * @gfp: allocation flags 7147 */ 7148 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7149 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, 7150 gfp_t gfp); 7151 7152 /** 7153 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX. 7154 * 7155 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7156 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length. 7157 * 7158 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7159 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate 7160 * information. 7161 * @len: frame length in bytes 7162 */ 7163 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7164 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status, 7165 int len); 7166 7167 /** 7168 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX. 7169 * 7170 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7171 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length. 7172 * 7173 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7174 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 7175 * @len: frame length in bytes 7176 */ 7177 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7178 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, 7179 int len); 7180 /** 7181 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading. 7182 * 7183 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3 7184 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the 7185 * hardware or firmware. 7186 * 7187 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7188 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off 7189 */ 7190 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable); 7191 7192 /** 7193 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template. 7194 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7195 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7196 * 7197 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7198 * 7199 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error. 7200 */ 7201 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7202 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7203 7204 /** 7205 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast 7206 * probe response template. 7207 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7208 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7209 * 7210 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7211 * 7212 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error. 7213 */ 7214 struct sk_buff * 7215 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7216 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7217 7218 /** 7219 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color 7220 * collision. 7221 * 7222 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7223 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is 7224 * aware of. 7225 * @gfp: allocation flags 7226 */ 7227 void 7228 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7229 u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp); 7230 7231 /** 7232 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame 7233 * 7234 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with 7235 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames. 7236 * 7237 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 7238 */ 7239 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb) 7240 { 7241 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb); 7242 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data; 7243 7244 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP || 7245 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control); 7246 } 7247 7248 /** 7249 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode 7250 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7251 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7252 * 7253 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface 7254 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active), 7255 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links. 7256 * 7257 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same 7258 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get 7259 * a sequence of calls like 7260 * - change_vif_links(0x11) 7261 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0) 7262 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP) 7263 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down) 7264 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0) 7265 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4) 7266 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP) 7267 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4) 7268 * - change_vif_links(0x10) 7269 * 7270 * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not 7271 * be called with any driver locks held that could cause a 7272 * lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks. 7273 */ 7274 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links); 7275 7276 /** 7277 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links 7278 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7279 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7280 * 7281 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only 7282 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and 7283 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be 7284 * completed after it returns. 7285 */ 7286 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7287 u16 active_links); 7288 7289 #endif /* MAC80211_H */ 7290